A transmission method for transmitting a first modulated signal and a second modulated signal in the same frequency at the same time. Each signal has been modulated according to a different modulation scheme. The transmission method applies precoding on both signals using a fixed precoding matrix, applies different power change to each signal, and regularly changes the phase of at least one of the signals, thereby improving received data signal quality for a reception device.
1. A transmission method comprising:
applying precoding to a first modulated signal s1 and a second modulated signal s2 to generate a first precoded signal z′1 and a second precoded signal z′2, the first modulated signal s1 having been modulated by a first modulation scheme at a modulation level denoted by a, the second modulated signal s2 having been modulated by a second modulation scheme at a modulation level denoted by b, and a and b being integers satisfying a<b;
performing a phase change on at least one of the first precoded signal z′1 and the second precoded signal z′2 to generate a first transmission signal z1 and a second transmission signal z2; and
transmitting the first transmission signal z1 and the second transmission signal z2 respectively from a first antenna and a second antenna at the same time at the same frequency,
the precoding being represented by a precoding matrix
where α=0,
a phase change scheme for the phase change being changed regularly, and
the transmission method further comprising:
performing a power change involving multiplication by a weighting factor ua and multiplication by a weighting factor ub, the weighting factor ua being used for the generation of the first transmission signal z1 from the first modulated signal s1, the weighting factor ub being used for the generation of the second transmission signal z2 from the second modulated signal s2, and the weighting factor ua and the weighting factor ub satisfying ua<ub.
2. A transmission apparatus comprising:
a weighting unit applying precoding to a first modulated signal s1 and a second modulated signal s2 to generate a first precoded signal z′1 and a second precoded signal z′2,
a phase changer performing a phase change on at least one of the first precoded signal z′1 and the second precoded signal z′2 to generate a first transmission signal z1 and a second transmission signal z2; and
a transmission unit transmitting the first transmission signal z1 and the second transmission signal z2 respectively from a first antenna and a second antenna at the same time at the same frequency,
the first modulated signal s1 having been modulated by a first modulation scheme at a modulation level denoted by a, the second modulated signal s2 having been modulated by a second modulation scheme at a modulation level denoted by b, and a and b being integers satisfying a<b,
the precoding being represented by a precoding matrix
where α=0,
a phase change scheme for the phase change being changed regularly, and
the transmission apparatus further comprising:
a power changer performing a power change involving multiplication by a weighting factor ua and multiplication by a weighting factor ub, the weighting factor ua being used for the generation of the first transmission signal z1 from the first modulated signal s1, the weighting factor ub being used for the generation of the second transmission signal z2 from the second modulated signal s2, and the weighting factor ua and the weighting factor ub satisfying ua<ub.
3. A reception method comprising:
acquiring a reception signal obtained by receiving a first transmission signal z1 and a second transmission signal z2 respectively transmitted from a first antenna and a second antenna at the same time at the same frequency, the first transmission signal z1 and the second transmission signal z2 having been generated by a predetermined generation process; and
obtaining reception data by applying a demodulation process corresponding to the predetermined generation process to the reception signal,
the predetermined generation process including:
applying precoding to a first modulated signal s1 and a second modulated signal s2 to generate a first precoded signal z′1 and a second precoded signal z′2; and
performing a phase change on at least one of the first precoded signal z′1 and the second precoded signal z′2 to generate the first transmission signal z1 and the second transmission signal z2,
the first modulated signal s1 having been modulated by a first modulation scheme at a modulation level denoted by a, the second modulated signal s2 having been modulated by a second modulation scheme at a modulation level denoted by b, a and b being integers satisfying a<b,
the precoding being represented by a precoding matrix
where α=0,
a phase change scheme for the phase change being changed regularly, and
the predetermined generation process further including:
performing a power change involving multiplication by a weighting factor ua and multiplication by a weighting factor ub, the weighting factor ua being used for the generation of the first transmission signal z1 from the first modulated signal s1, the weighting factor ub being used for the generation of the second transmission signal z2 from the second modulated signal s2, and the weighting factor ua and the weighting factor ub satisfying ua<ub.
4. A reception apparatus comprising:
an acquiring unit acquiring a reception signal obtained by receiving a first transmission signal z1 and a second transmission signal z2 respectively transmitted from a first antenna and a second antenna at the same time at the same frequency, the first transmission signal z1 and the second transmission signal z2 having been generated by a predetermined generation process; and
a demodulator obtaining reception data by applying a demodulation process corresponding to the predetermined generation process to the reception signal,
the predetermined generation process including:
applying precoding to a first modulated signal s1 and a second modulated signal s2 to generate a first precoded signal z′1 and a second precoded signal z′2; and
performing a phase change on at least one of the first precoded signal z′1 and the second precoded signal z′2 to generate the first transmission signal z1 and the second transmission signal z2,
the first modulated signal s1 having been modulated by a first modulation scheme at a modulation level denoted by a, the second modulated signal s2 having been modulated by a second modulation scheme at a modulation level denoted by b, a and b being integers satisfying a<b,
the precoding being represented by a precoding matrix
where α=0,
a phase change scheme for the phase change being changed regularly, and
the predetermined generation process further including:
performing a power change involving multiplication by a weighting factor ua and multiplication by a weighting factor ub, the weighting factor ua being used for the generation of the first transmission signal z1 from the first modulated signal s1, the weighting factor ub being used for the generation of the second transmission signal z2 from the second modulated signal s2, and the weighting factor ua and the weighting factor ub satisfying ua<ub.
|
This application is based on applications No. 2011-093540 filed in Japan on Apr. 19, 2011 and No. 2011-140749 filed in Japan on Jun. 24, 2011 the contents of which are hereby incorporated by reference.
The present invention relates to a signal generating method and a signal generating device for communication using multiple antennas.
A MIMO (Multiple-Input, Multiple-Output) system is an example of a conventional communication system using multiple antennas. In multi-antenna communication, of which the MIMO system is typical, multiple transmission signals are each modulated, and each modulated signal is simultaneously transmitted from a different antenna in order to increase the transmission speed of the data.
In this context, Patent Literature 1 suggests using a transmission device provided with a different interleaving pattern for each transmit antenna. That is, the transmission device from
As it happens, models of actual propagation environments in wireless communications include NLOS (Non Line-Of-Sight), typified by a Rayleigh fading environment, and LOS (Line-Of-Sight), typified by a Rician fading environment. When the transmission device transmits a single modulated signal, and the reception device performs maximal ratio combination on the signals received by a plurality of antennas and then demodulates and decodes the resulting signals, excellent reception quality can be achieved in a LOS environment, in particular in an environment where the Rician factor is large. The Rician factor represents the received power of direct waves relative to the received power of scattered waves. However, depending on the transmission system (e.g., a spatial multiplexing MIMO system), a problem occurs in that the reception quality deteriorates as the Rician factor increases (see Non-Patent Literature 3).
Broadcast or multicast communication is a service applied to various propagation environments. The radio wave propagation environment between the broadcaster and the receivers belonging to the users is often a LOS environment. When using a spatial multiplexing MIMO system having the above problem for broadcast or multicast communication, a situation may occur in which the received electric field strength is high at the reception device, but in which degradation in reception quality makes service reception impossible. In other words, in order to use a spatial multiplexing MIMO system in broadcast or multicast communication in both the NLOS environment and the LOS environment, a MIMO system that offers a certain degree of reception quality is desirable.
Non-Patent Literature 8 describes a method of selecting a codebook used in precoding (i.e. a precoding matrix, also referred to as a precoding weight matrix) based on feedback information from a communication party. However, Non-Patent Literature 8 does not at all disclose a method for precoding in an environment in which feedback information cannot be acquired from the other party, such as in the above broadcast or multicast communication.
On the other hand, Non-Patent Literature 4 discloses a method for switching the precoding matrix over time. This method is applicable when no feedback information is available. Non-Patent Literature 4 discloses using a unitary matrix as the precoding matrix, and switching the unitary matrix at random, but does not at all disclose a method applicable to degradation of reception quality in the above-described LOS environment. Non-Patent Literature 4 simply recites hopping between precoding matrices at random. Obviously, Non-Patent Literature 4 makes no mention whatsoever of a precoding method, or a structure of a precoding matrix, for remedying degradation of reception quality in a LOS environment.
[Patent Literature 1]
[Non-Patent Literature 1]
An object of the present invention is to provide a MIMO system that improves reception quality in a LOS environment.
The present invention provides a signal generation method for generating, from a plurality of baseband signals, a plurality of signals for transmission on a common frequency band and at a common time, comprising: performing a change of phase on each of a first baseband signal s1 generated from a first set of bits according to a first modulation scheme and a second baseband signal s2 generated from a second set of bits according to a second modulation scheme, thus generating a first post-phase-change baseband signal s1′ and a second post-phase-change baseband signal s2′; multiplying the first post-phase-change baseband signal s1′ by u and multiplying the second post-phase-change baseband signal s2′ by v, where u and v denote real numbers different from each other; and applying weighting according to a predetermined matrix F to the first post-phase-change baseband signal s1′×u and to the second post-phase-change baseband signal s2′×v, thus generating the plurality of signals for transmission on the common frequency band and at the common time as a first weighted signal z1 and a second weighted signal z2, wherein the first weighted signal z1 and the second weighted signal z2 satisfy the relation: (z1, z2)T=F(u×s1′, v×s2′)T, and the first modulation scheme is different from the second modulation scheme.
The present invention also provides a signal generation apparatus for generating, from a plurality of baseband signals, a plurality of signals for transmission on a common frequency band and at a common time, comprising: a phase changer performing a change of phase on each of a first baseband signal s1 generated from a first set of bits according to a first modulation scheme and a second baseband signal s2 generated from a second set of bits according to a second modulation scheme, thus generating a first post-phase-change baseband signal s1′ and a second post-phase-change baseband signal s2′; a power changer multiplying the first post-phase-change baseband signal s1′ by u and multiplying the second post-phase-change baseband signal s2′ by v, where u and v denote real numbers different from each other; and a weighting unit applying weighting according to a predetermined matrix F to the first post-phase-change baseband signal s1′×u and to the second post-phase-change baseband signal s2′×v, thus generating the plurality of signals for transmission on the common frequency band and at the common time as a first weighted signal z1 and a second weighted signal z2, wherein the first weighted signal z1 and the second weighted signal z2 satisfy the relation: (z1, z2)T=F(u×s1′, v×s2′)T, and the first modulation scheme is different from the second modulation scheme.
According to the above structure, the present invention provides a signal generation method and a signal generation apparatus that remedy degradation of reception quality in a LOS environment, thereby providing high-quality service to LOS users during broadcast or multicast communication.
Embodiments of the present invention are described below with reference to the accompanying drawings.
The following describes, in detail, a transmission method, a transmission device, a reception method, and a reception device pertaining to the present Embodiment.
Before beginning the description proper, an outline of transmission schemes and decoding schemes in a conventional spatial multiplexing MIMO system is provided.
Here, HNtNr is the channel matrix, n=(n1, . . . , nNr) is the noise vector, and the average value of ni is zero for independent and identically distributed (i.i.d) complex Gaussian noise of variance σ2. Based on the relationship between transmitted symbols introduced into a receiver and the received symbols, the probability distribution of the received vectors can be expressed as Math. 2 (formula 2), below, for a multi-dimensional Gaussian distribution.
Here, a receiver performing iterative decoding is considered. Such a receiver is illustrated in
(Iterative Detection Method)
The following describes the MIMO signal iterative detection performed by the Nt×Nr spatial multiplexing MIMO system. The log-likelihood ratio of umn is defined by Math. 6 (formula 6).
Through application of Bayes' theorem, Math. 6 (formula 6) can be expressed as Math. 7 (formula 7).
Note that Umn,±1={u|umn=±1}. Through the approximation ln Σaj˜max ln aj, Math. 7 (formula 7) can be approximated as Math. 8 (formula 8). The symbol ˜ is herein used to signify approximation.
In Math. 8 (formula 8), P(u|umn) and ln P(u|umn) can be expressed as follows.
Note that the log-probability of the equation given in Math. 2 (formula 2) can be expressed as Math. 12 (formula 12).
Accordingly, given Math. 7 (formula 7) and Math. 13 (formula 13), the posterior L-value for the MAP or APP (a posteriori probability) can be can be expressed as follows.
This is hereinafter termed iterative APP decoding. Also, given Math. 8 (formula 8) and Math. 12 (formula 12), the posterior L-value for the Max-log APP can be can be expressed as follows.
This is hereinafter referred to as iterative Max-log APP decoding. As such, the external information required by the iterative decoding system is obtainable by subtracting prior input from Math. 13 (formula 13) or from Math. 14 (formula 14).
(System Model)
The receiver performs iterative detection (iterative APP (or Max-log APP) decoding) of MIMO signals, as described above. The LDPC codes are decoded using, for example, sum-product decoding.
[Math. 16]
(ia,ja)=πa(Ωia,jaa) (formula 16)
[Math. 17]
(ib,jb)=πb(Ωib,jba) (formula 17)
Here, ia and ib represent the symbol order after interleaving, ja and jb represent the bit position in the modulation scheme (where ja,jb=1, . . . h), πa, and πb represent the interleavers of streams A and B, and Ωia,jaa and Ωib,jbb represent the data order of streams A and B before interleaving. Note that
(Iterative Decoding)
The following describes, in detail, the sum-product decoding used in decoding the LDPC codes and the MIMO signal iterative detection algorithm, both used by the receiver.
Sum-Product Decoding
A two-dimensional M×N matrix H={Hmn} is used as the check matrix for LDPC codes subject to decoding. For the set [1,N]={1, 2 . . . N}, the partial sets A(m) and B(n) are defined as follows.
[Math. 18]
A(m)≡{n:Hmn=1} (formula 18)
[Math. 19]
B(n)≡{m:Hmn=1} (formula 19)
Here, A(m) signifies the set of column indices equal to 1 for row m of check matrix H, while B(n) signifies the set of row indices equal to 1 for row n of check matrix H. The sum-product decoding algorithm is as follows.
Step A-1 (Initialization): For all pairs (m,n) satisfying Hmn=1, set the prior log ratio βmn=0. Set the loop variable (number of iterations) 1sum=1, and set the maximum number of loops 1sum,max.
Step A-2 (Processing): For all pairs (m,n) satisfying Hmn=1 in the order m=1, 2, . . . M, update the extrinsic value log ratio αmn using the following update formula.
where ƒ is the Gallager function. λn can then be computed as follows.
Step A-3 (Column Operations): For all pairs (m,n) satisfying Hmn=1 in the order n=1, 2, . . . N, update the extrinsic value log ratio βmn using the following update formula.
Step A-4 (Log-likelihood Ratio Calculation): For nε[1,N], the log-likelihood ratio Ln is computed as follows.
Step A-5 (Iteration Count): If 1sum<1sum,max, then 1sum is incremented and the process returns to step A-2. Sum-product decoding ends when 1sum=1sum,max.
The above describes one iteration of sum-product decoding operations. Afterward, MIMO signal iterative detection is performed. The variables m, n, αmn, βmn, λn, and Ln used in the above explanation of sum-product decoding operations are expressed as ma, na, αamana, βamana, λna, and Lna for stream A and as mb, nb, αbmbnb, βbmbnb, λnb, and Lnb for stream B.
(MIMO Signal Iterative Detection)
The following describes the calculation of λn for MIMO signal iterative detection.
The following formula is derivable from Math. 1 (formula 1).
Given the frame configuration illustrated in
[Math. 26]
na=Ωia,jaa (formula 26)
[Math. 27]
nb=Ωib,jbb (formula 27)
where na,nb ε[1,N]. For iteration k of MIMO signal iterative detection, the variables λna, Lna, λnb, and Lnb are expressed as λk,na, Lk,na, λκ,nb, and Lk,nb.
Step B-1 (Initial Detection; k=0) For initial wave detection, λo,na and λ0,nb are calculated as follows.
For iterative APP decoding:
For iterative Max-log APP decoding:
where X=a,b. Next, the iteration count for the MIMO signal iterative detection is set to 1mimo=0, with the maximum iteration count being 1mimo,max.
Step B-2 (Iterative Detection; Iteration k): When the iteration count is k, Math. 11 (formula 11), Math. 13 (formula 13) through Math. 15 (formula 15), Math. 16 (formula 16), and Math. 17 (formula 17) can be expressed as Math. 31 (formula 31) through Math. 34 (formula 34), below. Note that (X,Y)=(a,b)(b,a).
For iterative APP decoding:
For iterative Max-log APP decoding:
Step B-3 (Iteration Count and Codeword Estimation) If 1mimo<1mimo,max, then 1mimo is incremented and the process returns to step B-2. When 1mimo=1mimo,max, an estimated codeword is found, as follows.
where X=a,b.
An interleaver 304A takes the encoded data 303A and the frame configuration signal 313 as input, performs interleaving, i.e., rearranges the order thereof, and then outputs interleaved data 305A. (Depending on the frame configuration signal 313, the interleaving method may be switched.)
A mapper 306A takes the interleaved data 305A and the frame configuration signal 313 as input and performs modulation, such as (Quadrature Phase Shift Keying), 16-QAM (16-Quadradature Amplitude Modulation), or 64-QAM (64-Quadradture Amplitude Modulation) thereon, then outputs a baseband signal 307A. (Depending on the frame configuration signal 313, the modulation scheme may be switched.)
An encoder 302B takes information (data) 301B and the frame configuration signal 313 as input (which includes the error-correction method, coding rate, block length, and other information used by the encoder 302B in error-correction coding of the data, such that the method designated by the frame configuration signal 313 is used. The error-correction method may be switched). In accordance with the frame configuration signal 313, the encoder 302B performs error-correction coding, such as convolutional encoding, LDPC encoding, turbo encoding or similar, and outputs encoded data 303B.
An interleaver 304B takes the encoded data 303B and the frame configuration signal 313 as input, performs interleaving, i.e., rearranges the order thereof, and outputs interleaved data 305B. (Depending on the frame configuration signal 313, the interleaving method may be switched.)
A mapper 306B takes the interleaved data 305B and the frame configuration signal 313 as input and performs modulation, such as QPSK, 16-QAM, or 64-QAM thereon, then outputs a baseband signal 307B. (Depending on the frame configuration signal 313, the modulation scheme may be switched.)
A signal processing method information generator 314 takes the frame configuration signal 313 as input and accordingly outputs signal processing method information 315. The signal processing method information 315 designates the fixed precoding matrix to be used, and includes information on the pattern of phase changes used for changing the phase.
A weighting unit 308A takes baseband signal 307A, baseband signal 307B, and the signal processing method information 315 as input and, in accordance with the signal processing method information 315, performs weighting on the baseband signals 307A and 307B, then outputs a weighted signal 309A. The weighting method is described in detail, later.
A wireless unit 310A takes weighted signal 309A as input and performs processing such as quadrature modulation, band limitation, frequency conversion, amplification, and so on, then outputs transmit signal 311A. Transmit signal 311A is then output as radio waves by an antenna 312A.
A weighting unit 308B takes baseband signal 307A, baseband signal 307B, and the signal processing method information 315 as input and, in accordance with the signal processing method information 315, performs weighting on the baseband signals 307A and 307B, then outputs weighted signal 316B.
Both weighting units perform weighting using a fixed precoding matrix. The precoding matrix uses, for example, the method of Math. 36 (formula 36), and satisfies the conditions of Math. 37 (formula 37) or Math. 38 (formula 38), all found below. However, this is only an example. The value of α is not restricted to Math. 37 (formula 37) and Math. 38 (formula 38), and may take on other values, e.g., α=1.
Here, the precoding matrix is
In Math. 36 (formula 36), above, α is given by:
Alternatively, in Math. 36 (formula 36), above, α may be given by:
The precoding matrix is not restricted to that of Math. 36 (formula 36), but may also be as indicated by Math. 39 (formula 39).
In Math. 39 (formula 39), let a=Aejδ11, b=Bejδ12, c=Cejδ21, and d=Dejδ22. Further, one of a, b, c, and d may be equal to zero. For example, the following configurations are possible: (1) a may be zero while b, c, and d are non-zero, (2) b may be zero while a, c, and d are non-zero, (3) c may be zero while a, b, and d are non-zero, or (4) d may be zero while a, b, and c are non-zero.
When any of the modulation scheme, error-correcting codes, and the coding rate thereof are changed, the precoding matrix may also be set, changed, and fixed for use.
A phase changer 317B takes weighted signal 316B and the signal processing method information 315 as input, then regularly changes the phase of the signal 316B for output. This regular change is a change of phase performed according to a predetermined phase changing pattern having a predetermined period (cycle) (e.g., every n symbols (n being an integer, n≧1) or at a predetermined interval). The details of the phase changing pattern are explained below, in Embodiment 4.
Wireless unit 310B takes post-phase change signal 309B as input and performs processing such as quadrature modulation, band limitation, frequency conversion, amplification, and so on, then outputs transmit signal 311B. Transmit signal 311B is then output as radio waves by an antenna 312B.
An encoder 402 takes information (data) 401 and the frame configuration signal 313 as input, and, in accordance with the frame configuration signal 313, performs error-correction coding and outputs encoded data 402.
A distributor 404 takes the encoded data 403 as input, performs distribution thereof, and outputs data 405A and data 405B. Although
Symbol 501_1 is for estimating channel fluctuations for modulated signal z1(t) (where t is time) transmitted by the transmission device. Symbol 502_1 is a data symbol transmitted by modulated signal z1(t) as symbol number u (in the time domain). Symbol 503_1 is a data symbol transmitted by modulated signal z1(t) as symbol number u+1.
Symbol 501_2 is for estimating channel fluctuations for modulated signal z2(t) (where t is time) transmitted by the transmission device. Symbol 502_2 is a data symbol transmitted by modulated signal z2(t) as symbol number u. Symbol 503_2 is a data symbol transmitted by modulated signal z1(t) as symbol number u+1.
Here, the symbols of z1(t) and of z2(t) having the same timestamp (identical timing) are transmitted from the transmit antenna using the same (shared/common) frequency.
The following describes the relationships between the modulated signals z1(t) and z2(t) transmitted by the transmission device and the received signals r1(t) and r2(t) received by the reception device.
In
Here, given vector W1=(w11,w12) from the first row of the fixed precoding matrix F, z1(t) is expressible as Math. 41 (formula 41), below.
[Math. 41]
z1(t)=W1×(s1(t),s2(t))T (formula 41)
Similarly, given vector W2=(w21,w22) from the second row of the fixed precoding matrix F, and letting the phase changing formula applied by the phase changer by y(t), then z2(t) is expressible as Math. 42 (formula 42), below.
[Math. 42]
z2(t)=y(t)×W2×(s1(t),s2(t))T (formula 42)
Here, y(t) is a phase changing formula obeying a predetermined method. For example, given a period (cycle) of four and timestamp u, the phase changing formula may be expressed as Math. 43 (formula 43), below.
[Math. 43]
y(u)=ej0 (formula 43)
Similarly, the phase changing formula for timestamp u+1 may be, for example, as given by Math. 44 (formula 44).
That is, the phase changing formula for timestamp u+k generalizes to Math. 45 (formula 45).
Note that Math. 43 (formula 43) through Math. 45 (formula 45) are given only as an example of a regular change of phase.
The regular change of phase is not restricted to a period (cycle) of four. Improved reception capabilities (the error-correction capabilities, to be exact) may potentially be promoted in the reception device by increasing the period (cycle) number (this does not mean that a greater period (cycle) is better, though avoiding small numbers such as two is likely ideal).
Furthermore, although Math. 43 (formula 43) through Math. 45 (formula 45), above, represent a configuration in which a change in phase is carried out through rotation by consecutive predetermined phases (in the above formula, every π/2), the change in phase need not be rotation by a constant amount, but may also be random. For example, in accordance with the predetermined period (cycle) of y(t), the phase may be changed through sequential multiplication as shown in Math. 46 (formula 46) and Math. 47 (formula 47). The key point of the regular change of phase is that the phase of the modulated signal is regularly changed. The phase changing degree variance rate is preferably as even as possible, such as from −π radians to π radians. However, given that this concerns a distribution, random variance is also possible.
As such, the weighting unit 600 of
When a specialized precoding matrix is used in the LOS environment, the reception quality is likely to improve tremendously. However, depending on the direct wave conditions, the phase and amplitude components of the direct wave may greatly differ from the specialized precoding matrix, upon reception. The LOS environment has certain rules. Thus, data reception quality is tremendously improved through a regular change of transmit signal phase that obeys those rules. The present invention offers a signal processing method for improving the LOS environment.
Channel fluctuation estimator 705_1 for modulated signal z1 transmitted by the transmission device takes baseband signal 704_X as input, extracts reference symbol 501_1 for channel estimation from
Channel fluctuation estimator 705_2 for modulated signal z2 transmitted by the transmission device takes baseband signal 704_X as input, extracts reference symbol 502_2 for channel estimation from
Wireless unit 703_Y receives, as input, received signal 702_Y received by antenna 701_Y, performs processing such as frequency conversion, quadrature demodulation, and the like, and outputs baseband signal 704_Y.
Channel fluctuation estimator 707_1 for modulated signal z1 transmitted by the transmission device takes baseband signal 704_Y as input, extracts reference symbol 501_1 for channel estimation from
Channel fluctuation estimator 707_2 for modulated signal z2 transmitted by the transmission device takes baseband signal 704_Y as input, extracts reference symbol 502_2 for channel estimation from
A control information decoder 709 receives baseband signal 704_X and baseband signal 704_Y as input, detects symbol 500_1 that indicates the transmission scheme from
A signal processor 711 takes the baseband signals 704_X and 704_Y, the channel estimation signals 706_1, 706_2, 708_1, and 708_2, and the transmission method information signal 710 as input, performs detection and decoding, and then outputs received data 712_1 and 712_2.
Next, the operations of the signal processor 711 from
Here, the reception device may use the decoding methods of Non-Patent Literature 2 and 3 on R(t) by computing H(t)×Y(t)×F.
Accordingly, the coefficient generator 819 from
The inner MIMO detector 803 takes the signal processing method information signal 820 as input and performs iterative detection and decoding using the signal and the relationship thereof to Math. 48 (formula 48). The operations thereof are described below.
The processing unit illustrated in
In
Subsequent operations are described separately for initial detection and for iterative decoding (iterative detection).
(Initial Detection)
The inner MIMO detector 803 takes baseband signal 801X, channel estimation signal group 802X, baseband signal 801Y, and channel estimation signal group 802Y as input. Here, the modulation scheme for modulated signal (stream) s1 and modulated signal (stream) s2 is described as 16-QAM.
The inner MIMO detector 803 first computes H(t)×Y(t)×F from the channel estimation signal groups 802X and 802Y, thus calculating a candidate signal point corresponding to baseband signal 801X.
Similarly, the inner MIMO detector 803 computes H(t)×Y(t)×F from the channel estimation signal groups 802X and 802Y, calculates candidate signal points corresponding to baseband signal 801Y, computes the Euclidean squared distance between each of the candidate signal points and the received signal points (corresponding to baseband signal 801Y), and divides the Euclidean squared distance by the noise variance σ2. Accordingly, EY(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) is calculated. That is, EY is the Euclidian squared distance between a candidate signal point corresponding to (b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) and a received signal point, divided by the noise variance.
Next, EX(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7)+EY(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7)=E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) is computed.
The inner MIMO detector 803 outputs E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) as the signal 804.
The log-likelihood calculator 805A takes the signal 804 as input, calculates the log-likelihood of bits b0, b1, b2, and b3, and outputs the log-likelihood signal 806A. Note that this log-likelihood calculation produces the log-likelihood of a bit being 1 and the log-likelihood of a bit being 0. The calculation method is as shown in Math. 28 (formula 28), Math. 29 (formula 29), and Math. 30 (formula 30), and the details thereof are given by Non-Patent Literature 2 and 3.
Similarly, log-likelihood calculator 805B takes the signal 804 as input, calculates the log-likelihood of bits b4, b5, b6, and b7, and outputs log-likelihood signal 806B.
A deinterleaver (807A) takes log-likelihood signal 806A as input, performs deinterleaving corresponding to that of the interleaver (the interleaver (304A) from
Similarly, a deinterleaver (807B) takes log-likelihood signal 806B as input, performs deinterleaving corresponding to that of the interleaver (the interleaver (304B) from
Log-likelihood ratio calculator 809A takes deinterleaved log-likelihood signal 808A as input, calculates the log-likelihood ratio of the bits encoded by encoder 302A from
Similarly, log-likelihood ratio calculator 809B takes deinterleaved log-likelihood signal 808B as input, calculates the log-likelihood ratio of the bits encoded by encoder 302B from
Soft-in/soft-out decoder 811A takes log-likelihood ratio signal 810A as input, performs decoding, and outputs a decoded log-likelihood ratio 812A.
Similarly, soft-in/soft-out decoder 811B takes log-likelihood ratio signal 810B as input, performs decoding, and outputs decoded log-likelihood ratio 812B.
(Iterative Decoding (Iterative Detection), k Iterations)
The interleaver (813A) takes the k−1th decoded log-likelihood ratio 812A decoded by the soft-in/soft-out decoder as input, performs interleaving, and outputs an interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814A. Here, the interleaving pattern used by the interleaver (813A) is identical to that of the interleaver (304A) from
Another interleaver (813B) takes the k−1th decoded log-likelihood ratio 812B decoded by the soft-in/soft-out decoder as input, performs interleaving, and outputs interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814B. Here, the interleaving pattern used by the interleaver (813B) is identical to that of the other interleaver (304B) from
The inner MIMO detector 803 takes baseband signal 816X, transformed channel estimation signal group 817X, baseband signal 816Y, transformed channel estimation signal group 817Y, interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814A, and interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814B as input. Here, baseband signal 816X, transformed channel estimation signal group 817X, baseband signal 816Y, and transformed channel estimation signal group 817Y are used instead of baseband signal 801X, channel estimation signal group 802X, baseband signal 801Y, and channel estimation signal group 802Y because the latter cause delays due to the iterative decoding.
The iterative decoding operations of the inner MIMO detector 803 differ from the initial detection operations thereof in that the interleaved log-likelihood ratios 814A and 814B are used in signal processing for the former. The inner MIMO detector 803 first calculates E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) in the same manner as for initial detection. In addition, the coefficients corresponding to Math. 11 (formula 11) and Math. 32 (formula 32) are computed from the interleaved log-likelihood ratios 814A and 814B. The value of E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) is corrected using the coefficients so calculated to obtain E′(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7), which is output as the signal 804.
The log-likelihood calculator 805A takes the signal 804 as input, calculates the log-likelihood of bits b0, b1, b2, and b3, and outputs the log-likelihood signal 806A. Note that this log-likelihood calculation produces the log-likelihood of a bit being 1 and the log-likelihood of a bit being 0. The calculation method is as shown in Math. 31 (formula 31) through Math. 35 (formula 35), and the details are given by Non-Patent Literature 2 and 3.
Similarly, log-likelihood calculator 805B takes the signal 804 as input, calculates the log-likelihood of bits b4, b5, b6, and b7, and outputs log-likelihood signal 806B. Operations performed by the deinterleaver onwards are similar to those performed for initial detection.
While
The key point for the present Embodiment is the calculation of H(t)×Y(t)×F. As shown in Non-Patent Literature 5 and the like, QR decomposition may also be used to perform initial detection and iterative detection.
Also, as indicated by Non-Patent Literature 11, MMSE (Minimum Mean-Square Error) and ZF (Zero-Forcing) linear operations may be performed based on H(t)×Y(t)×F when performing initial detection.
As described above, when a transmission device according to the present Embodiment using a MIMO system transmits a plurality of modulated signals from a plurality of antennas, changing the phase over time while multiplying by the precoding matrix so as to regularly change the phase results in improvements to data reception quality for a reception device in a LOS environment, where direct waves are dominant, compared to a conventional spatial multiplexing MIMO system.
In the present Embodiment, and particularly in the configuration of the reception device, the number of antennas is limited and explanations are given accordingly. However, the Embodiment may also be applied to a greater number of antennas. In other words, the number of antennas in the reception device does not affect the operations or advantageous effects of the present Embodiment.
Also, although LDPC codes are described as a particular example, the present Embodiment is not limited in this manner, Furthermore, the decoding method is not limited to the sum-product decoding example given for the soft-in/soft-out decoder. Other soft-in/soft-out decoding methods, such as the BCJR algorithm, SOVA, and the Max-Log-Map algorithm may also be used. Details are provided in Non-Patent Literature 6.
In addition, although the present Embodiment is described using a single-carrier method, no limitation is intended in this regard. The present Embodiment is also applicable to multi-carrier transmission. Accordingly, the present Embodiment may also be realized using, for example, spread-spectrum communications, OFDM, SC-FDMA (Single Carrier Frequency-Division Multiple Access), SC-OFDM, wavelet OFDM as described in Non-Patent Literature 7, and so on. Furthermore, in the present Embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, and so on) or symbols transmitting control information, may be arranged within the frame in any manner.
The following describes an example in which OFDM is used as a multi-carrier method.
An OFDM-related processor 1201A takes weighted signal 309A as input, performs OFDM-related processing thereon, and outputs transmit signal 1202A. Similarly, OFDM-related processor 1201B takes post-phase change signal 309B as input, performs OFDM-related processing thereon, and outputs transmit signal 1202B.
Serial-to-parallel converter 1302A performs serial-to-parallel conversion on weighted signal 1301A (corresponding to weighted signal 309A from
Reorderer 1304A takes parallel signal 1303A as input, performs reordering thereof, and outputs reordered signal 1305A. Reordering is described in detail later.
IFFT (Inverse Fast Fourier Transform) unit 1306A takes reordered signal 1305A as input, applies an IFFT thereto, and outputs post-IFFT signal 1307A.
Wireless unit 1308A takes post-IFFT signal 1307A as input, performs processing such as frequency conversion and amplification, thereon, and outputs modulated signal 1309A. Modulated signal 1309A is then output as radio waves by antenna 1310A.
Serial-to-parallel converter 1302B performs serial-to-parallel conversion on weighted signal 1301B (corresponding to post-phase change 309B from
Reorderer 1304B takes parallel signal 1303B as input, performs reordering thereof, and outputs reordered signal 1305B. Reordering is described in detail later.
IFFT unit 1306B takes reordered signal 1305B as input, applies an IFFT thereto, and outputs post-IFFT signal 1307B.
Wireless unit 1308B takes post-IFFT signal 1307B as input, performs processing such as frequency conversion and amplification thereon, and outputs modulated signal 1309B. Modulated signal 1309B is then output as radio waves by antenna 1310A.
The transmission device from
As shown in
Similarly, with respect to the symbols of weighted signal 1301B input to serial-to-parallel converter 1302B, the assigned ordering is #0, #1, #2, #3, and so on. Here, given that the example deals with a period (cycle) of four, a different change in phase is applied to each of #0, #1, #2, and #3, which are equivalent to one period (cycle). Similarly, a different change in phase is applied to each of #4n, #4n+1, #4n+2, and #4n+3 (n being a non-zero positive integer), which are also equivalent to one period (cycle).
As shown in
The symbol group 1402 shown in
In the present Embodiment, modulated signal z1 shown in
As such, when using a multi-carrier transmission method such as OFDM, and unlike single carrier transmission, symbols can be arranged in the frequency domain. Of course, the symbol arrangement method is not limited to those illustrated by
While
In
Here, symbol #0 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u, symbol #1 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+1, symbol #2 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+2, and symbol #3 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+3.
Similarly, for frequency-domain symbol group 2220, symbol #4 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u, symbol #5 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+1, symbol #6 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+2, and symbol #7 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+3.
The above-described change of phase is applied to the symbol at timestamp $1. However, in order to apply periodic shifting with respect to the time domain, the following change of phases are applied to symbol groups 2201, 2202, 2203, and 2204.
For time-domain symbol group 2201, symbol #0 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u, symbol #9 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+1, symbol #18 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+2, and symbol #27 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+3.
For time-domain symbol group 2202, symbol #28 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u, symbol #1 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+1, symbol #10 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+2, and symbol #19 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+3.
For time-domain symbol group 2203, symbol #20 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u, symbol #29 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+1, symbol #2 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+2, and symbol #11 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+3.
For time-domain symbol group 2204, symbol #12 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u, symbol #21 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+1, symbol #30 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+2, and symbol #3 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+3.
The characteristic feature of
Although
In Embodiment 1, described above, phase changing is applied to a weighted (precoded with a fixed precoding matrix) signal z(t). The following Embodiments describe various phase changing methods by which the effects of Embodiment 1 may be obtained.
In the above-described Embodiment, as shown in
However, phase changing may also be applied before precoding is performed by the weighting unit 600. In addition to the components illustrated in FIG. 6, the transmission device may also feature the weighting unit 600 before the phase changer 317B, as shown in
In such circumstances, the following configuration is possible. The phase changer 317B performs a regular change of phase with respect to baseband signal s2(t), on which mapping has been performed according to a selected modulation scheme, and outputs s2′(t)=s2(t)y(t) (where y(t) varies over time t). The weighting unit 600 executes precoding on s2′t, outputs z2(t)=W2s2′(t) (see Math. 42 (formula 42)) and the result is then transmitted.
Alternatively, phase changing may be performed on both modulated signals s1(t) and s2(t). As such, the transmission device is configured so as to include a phase changer taking both signals output by the weighting unit 600, as shown in
Like phase changer 317B, phase changer 317A performs regular a regular change of phase on the signal input thereto, and as such changes the phase of signal z1′(t) precoded by the weighting unit. Post-phase change signal z1(t) is then output to a transmitter.
However, the phase changing rate applied by the phase changers 317A and 317B varies simultaneously in order to perform the phase changing shown in
Also, as described above, a change of phase may be performed before precoding is performed by the weighting unit. In such a case, the transmission device should be configured as illustrated in
When a change of phase is carried out on both modulated signals, each of the transmit signals is, for example, control information that includes information about the phase changing pattern. By obtaining the control information, the reception device knows the phase changing method by which the transmission device regularly varies the change, i.e., the phase changing pattern, and is thus able to demodulate (decode) the signals correctly.
Next, variants of the sample configurations shown in
Phase changer 317A of
Here, a change of phase having a period (cycle) of four is, for example, applied to z1′(t). (Meanwhile, the phase of z2′(t) is not changed.) Accordingly, for timestamp u, y1(u)=ej0 and y2(u)=1, for timestamp u+1, y1(u+1)=ejπ/2 and y2(u+1)=1, for timestamp u+2, y1(u+2)=ejπ and y2(u+2)=1, and for timestamp u+3, y1(u+3)=ej3π/2 and y2(u+3)=1.
Next, a change of phase having a period (cycle) of four is, for example, applied to z2′(t). (Meanwhile, the phase of z1′(t) is not changed.) Accordingly, for timestamp u+4, y1(u+4)=1 and y2(u+4)=ej0, for timestamp u+5, y1(u+5)=1 and y2(u+5)=ejπ/2, for timestamp u+6, y1(u+6)=1 and y2(u+6)=ejπ, and for timestamp u+7, y1(u+7)=1 and y2(u+7)=ej3π/2.
Accordingly, given the above examples.
for any timestamp 8k, y1(8k)=ej0 and y2(8k)=1,
for any timestamp 8k+1, y1(8k+1)=ejπ/2 and y2(8k+1)=1,
for any timestamp 8k+2, y1(8k+2)=ejπ and y2(8k+2)=1,
for any timestamp 8k+3, y1(8k+3)=ej3π/2 and y2(8k+3)=1,
for any timestamp 8k+4, y1(8k+4)=1 and y2(8k+4)=ej0,
for any timestamp 8k+5, y1(8k+3)=1 and y2(8k+5)=ejπ/2,
for any timestamp 8k+6, y1(8k+6)=1 and y2(8k+6)=ejπ, and
for any timestamp 8k+7, y1(8k+7)=1 and y2(8k+7)=ej3π/2.
As described above, there are two intervals, one where the change of phase is performed on z1′(t) only, and one where the change of phase is performed on z2′(t) only. Furthermore, the two intervals form a phase changing period (cycle). While the above explanation describes the interval where the change of phase is performed on z1′(t) only and the interval where the change of phase is performed on z2′(t) only as being equal, no limitation is intended in this manner. The two intervals may also differ. In addition, while the above explanation describes performing a change of phase having a period (cycle) of four on z1′(t) only and then performing a change of phase having a period (cycle) of four on z2′(t) only, no limitation is intended in this manner. The changes of phase may be performed on z1′(t) and on z2′(t) in any order (e.g., the change of phase may alternate between being performed on z1′(t) and on z2′(t), or may be performed in random order).
Phase changer 317A of
Here, a change of phase having a period (cycle) of four is, for example, applied to s1(t). (Meanwhile, s2(t) remains unchanged). Accordingly, for timestamp u, y1(u)=ej0 and y2(u)=1, for timestamp u+1, y1(u+1)=ejπ/2 and y2(u+1)=1, for timestamp u+2, y1(u+2)=ejπ and y2(u+2)=1, and for timestamp u+3, y1(u+3)=ej3π/2 and y2(u+3)=1.
Next, a change of phase having a period (cycle) of four is, for example, applied to s2(t). (Meanwhile, s1(t) remains unchanged). Accordingly, for timestamp u+4, y1(u+4)=1 and y2(u+4)=ej0, for timestamp u+5, y1(u+5)=1 and y2(u+5)=ejπ/2, for timestamp u+6, y1(u+6)=1 and y2(u+6)=ejπ, and for timestamp u+7, y1(u+7)=1 and y2(u+7)=ej3π/2.
Accordingly, given the above examples,
for any timestamp 8k, y1(8k)=ej0 and y2(8k)=1,
for any timestamp 8k+1, y1(8k+1)=ejπ/2 and y2(8k+1)=1,
for any timestamp 8k+2, y1(8k+2)=ejπ and y2(8k+2)=1,
for any timestamp 8k+3, y1(8k+3)=ej3π/2 and y2(8k+3)=1,
for any timestamp 8k+4, y1(8k+4)=1 and y2(8k+4)=ej0,
for any timestamp 8k+5, y1(8k+3)=1 and y2(8k+5)=ejπ/2,
for any timestamp 8k+6, y1(8k+6)=1 and y2(8k+6)=ejπ, and
for any timestamp 8k+7, y1(8k+7)=1 and y2(8k+7)=ej3π/2.
As described above, there are two intervals, one where the change of phase is performed on s1(t) only, and one where the change of phase is performed on s2(t) only. Furthermore, the two intervals form a phase changing period (cycle). Although the above explanation describes the interval where the change of phase is performed on s1(t) only and the interval where the change of phase is performed on s2(t) only as being equal, no limitation is intended in this manner. The two intervals may also differ. In addition, while the above explanation describes performing the change of phase having a period (cycle) of four on s1(t) only and then performing the change of phase having a period (cycle) of four on s2(t) only, no limitation is intended in this manner. The changes of phase may be performed on s1(t) and on s2(t) in any order (e.g., may alternate between being performed on s1(t) and on s2(t), or may be performed in random order).
Accordingly, the reception conditions under which the reception device receives each transmit signal z1(t) and z2(t) are equalized. By periodically switching the phase of the symbols in the received signals z1(t) and z2(t), the ability of the error corrected codes to correct errors may be improved, thus ameliorating received signal quality in the LOS environment.
Accordingly, Embodiment 2 as described above is able to produce the same results as the previously described Embodiment 1.
Although the present Embodiment used a single-carrier method, i.e., time domain phase changing, as an example, no limitation is intended in this regard. The same effects are also achievable using multi-carrier transmission. Accordingly, the present Embodiment may also be realized using, for example, spread-spectrum communications, OFDM, SC-FDMA (Single Carrier Frequency-Division Multiple Access), SC-OFDM, wavelet OFDM as described in Non-Patent Literature 7, and so on. As previously described, while the present Embodiment explains the change of phase as changing the phase with respect to the time domain t, the phase may alternatively be changed with respect to the frequency domain as described in Embodiment 1. That is, considering the phase changing method in the time domain t described in the present Embodiment and replacing t with f (f being the ((sub-) carrier) frequency) leads to a change of phase applicable to the frequency domain. Also, as explained above for Embodiment 1, the phase changing method of the present Embodiment is also applicable to a change of phase with respect to both the time domain and the frequency domain.
Accordingly, although
Furthermore, in the present Embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, etc) or symbols transmitting control information, may be arranged within the frame in any manner.
Embodiments 1 and 2, described above, discuss regular changes of phase. Embodiment 3 describes a method of allowing the reception device to obtain good received signal quality for data, regardless of the reception device arrangement, by considering the location of the reception device with respect to the transmission device.
Embodiment 3 concerns the symbol arrangement within signals obtained through a change of phase.
First, an example is explained in which the change of phase is performed one of two baseband signals, precoded as explained in Embodiment 1 (see
(Although
Consider symbol 3100 at carrier 2 and timestamp $2 of
Within carrier 2, there is a very strong correlation between the channel conditions for symbol 3100A at carrier 2, timestamp $2 and the channel conditions for the time domain nearest-neighbour symbols to timestamp $2, i.e., symbol 3013 at timestamp $1 and symbol 3101 at timestamp $3 within carrier 2.
Similarly, for timestamp $2, there is a very strong correlation between the channel conditions for symbol 3100 at carrier 2, timestamp $2 and the channel conditions for the frequency-domain nearest-neighbour symbols to carrier 2, i.e., symbol 3104 at carrier 1, timestamp $2 and symbol 3104 at timestamp $2, carrier 3.
As described above, there is a very strong correlation between the channel conditions for symbol 3100 and the channel conditions for each symbol 3101, 3102, 3103, and 3104.
The present description considers N different phases (N being an integer, N≧2) for multiplication in a transmission method where the phase is regularly changed. The symbols illustrated in
The present Embodiment takes advantage of the high correlation in channel conditions existing between neighbouring symbols in the frequency domain and/or neighbouring symbols in the time domain in a symbol arrangement enabling high data reception quality to be obtained by the reception device receiving the phase-changed symbols.
In order to achieve this high data reception quality, conditions #1 and #2 are necessary.
(Condition #1)
As shown in
(Condition #2)
As shown in
Ideally, data symbols satisfying Condition #1 should be present. Similarly, data symbols satisfying Condition #2 should be present.
The reasons supporting Conditions #1 and #2 are as follows.
A very strong correlation exists between the channel conditions of given symbol of a transmit signal (hereinafter, symbol A) and the channel conditions of the symbols neighbouring symbol A in the time domain, as described above.
Accordingly, when three neighbouring symbols in the time domain each have different phases, then despite reception quality degradation in the LOS environment (poor signal quality caused by degradation in conditions due to phase relations despite high signal quality in terms of SNR) for symbol A, the two remaining symbols neighbouring symbol A are highly likely to provide good reception quality. As a result, good received signal quality is achievable after error correction and decoding.
Similarly, a very strong correlation exists between the channel conditions of given symbol of a transmit signal (hereinafter, symbol A) and the channel conditions of the symbols neighbouring symbol A in the frequency domain, as described above.
Accordingly, when three neighbouring symbols in the frequency domain each have different phases, then despite reception quality degradation in the LOS environment (poor signal quality caused by degradation in conditions due to direct wave phase relationships despite high signal quality in terms of SNR) for symbol A, the two remaining symbols neighbouring symbol A are highly likely to provide good reception quality. As a result, good received signal quality is achievable after error correction and decoding.
Combining Conditions #1 and #2, ever greater data reception quality is likely achievable for the reception device. Accordingly, the following Condition #3 can be derived.
(Condition #3)
As shown in
Here, the different changes in phase are as follows. Phase changes are defined from 0 radians to 2π radians. For example, for time X, carrier Y, a phase change of ejθX,Y is applied to precoded baseband signal z2′ from
Ideally, data symbols satisfying Condition #3 should be present.
As evident from
In other words, in
Similarly, in
Similarly, in
The following describes an example in which a change of phase is performed on two precoded baseband signals, as explained in Embodiment 2 (see
When a change of phase is performed on precoded baseband signal z1′ and precoded baseband signal z2′ as shown in
Scheme 1 involves a change in phase of precoded baseband signal z2′ as described above, to achieve the change in phase illustrated by
The symbols illustrated in
As shown in
As described above, the change in phase performed on precoded baseband signal z2′ has a period (cycle) of ten, but the period (cycle) can be effectively made greater than ten by taking the change in phase applied to precoded baseband signal z1′ and to precoded baseband signal z2′ into consideration. Accordingly, data reception quality may be improved for the reception device.
Scheme 2 involves a change in phase of precoded baseband signal z2′ as described above, to achieve the change in phase illustrated by
The symbols illustrated in
As described above, the change in phase performed on precoded baseband signal z2′ has a period (cycle) of ten, but by taking the changes in phase applied to precoded baseband signal z1′ and precoded baseband signal z2′ into consideration, the period (cycle) can be effectively made equivalent to 30 for both precoded baseband signals z1′ and z2′. Accordingly, data reception quality may be improved for the reception device. An effective way of applying method 2 is to perform a change in phase on precoded baseband signal z1′ with a period (cycle) of N and perform a change in phase on precoded baseband signal z2′ with a period (cycle) of M such that N and M are coprime. As such, by taking both precoded baseband signals z1′ and z2′ into consideration, a period (cycle) of N×M is easily achievable, effectively making the period (cycle) greater when N and M are coprime.
The above describes an example of the phase changing method pertaining to Embodiment 3. The present invention is not limited in this manner. As explained for Embodiments 1 and 2, a change in phase may be performed with respect the frequency domain or the time domain, or on time-frequency blocks. Similar improvement to the data reception quality can be obtained for the reception device in all cases.
The same also applies to frames having a configuration other than that described above, where pilot symbols (SP symbols) and symbols transmitting control information are inserted among the data symbols. The details of the change in phase in such circumstances are as follows.
The key point of
The key point of
The key point of
The key point of
In
In
Although not indicated in the frame configurations from
Wireless units 310A and 310B of
A selector 5301 takes the plurality of baseband signals as input and selects a baseband signal having a symbol indicated by the frame configuration signal 313 for output.
Similarly, as shown in
The above explanations are given using pilot symbols, control symbols, and data symbols as examples. However, the present invention is not limited in this manner. When symbols are transmitted using methods other than precoding, such as single-antenna transmission or transmission using space-time block coding, not performing a change of phase is important. Conversely, performing a change of phase on symbols that have been precoded is the key point of the present invention.
Accordingly, a characteristic feature of the present invention is that the change of phase is not performed on all symbols within the frame configuration in the time-frequency domain, but only performed on signals that have been precoded.
Embodiments 1 and 2, described above, discuss a regular change of phase. Embodiment 3, however, discloses performing a different change of phase on neighbouring symbols.
The present Embodiment describes a phase changing method that varies according to the modulation scheme and the coding rate of the error-correcting codes used by the transmission device.
Table 1, below, is a list of phase changing method settings corresponding to the settings and parameters of the transmission device.
TABLE 1
No. of Modulated
Phase
Transmission
Modulation
Changing
Signals
Scheme
Coding Rate
Pattern
2
#1: QPSK,
#1: 1/2,
#1: —,
#2: QPSK
#2 2/3
#2: A
2
#1: QPSK,
#1: 1/2,
#1: A,
#2: QPSK
#2: 3/4
#2: B
2
#1: QPSK,
#1: 2/3,
#1: A,
#2: QPSK
#2: 3/5
#2: C
2
#1: QPSK,
#1: 2/3,
#1: C,
#2: QPSK
#2: 2/3
#2: —
2
#1: QPSK,
#1: 3/3,
#1: D,
#2: QPSK
#2: 5/6
#2: E
2
#1: QPSK,
#1: 1/2,
#1: B,
#2: 16-QAM
#2: 2/3
#2: A
2
#1: QPSK,
#1: 1/2,
#1: A,
#2: 16-QAM
#2: 3/4
#2: C
2
#1: QPSK,
#1: 1/2,
#1: —,
#2: 16-QAM
#2: 3/5
#2: E
2
#1: QPSK,
#1: 2/3,
#1: D,
#2: 16-QAM
#2: 3/4
#2: —
2
#1: QPSK,
#1: 2/3,
#1: D,
#2: 16-QAM
#2: 5/6
#2: B
2
#1: 16-QAM,
#1: 1/2,
#1: —,
#2: 16-QAM
#2: 2/3
#2: E
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
In Table 1, #1 denotes modulated signal s1 from Embodiment 1 described above (baseband signal s1 modulated with the modulation scheme set by the transmission device) and #2 denotes modulated signal s2 (baseband signal s2 modulated with the modulation scheme set by the transmission device). The coding rate column of Table 1 indicates the coding rate of the error-correcting codes for modulation schemes #1 and #2. The phase changing pattern column of Table 1 indicates the phase changing method applied to precoded baseband signals z1 (z1′) and z2 (z2′), as explained in Embodiments 1 through 3. Although the phase changing patterns are labelled A, B, C, D, E, and so on, this refers to the phase change degree applied, for example, in a phase changing pattern given by Math. 46 (formula 46) and Math. 47 (formula 47), above. In the phase changing pattern column of Table 1, the dash signifies that no change of phase is applied.
The combinations of modulation scheme and coding rate listed in Table 1 are examples. Other modulation schemes (such as 128-QAM and 256-QAM) and coding rates (such as ⅞) not listed in Table 1 may also be included. Also, as described in Embodiment 1, the error-correcting codes used for s1 and s2 may differ (Table 1 is given for cases where a single type of error-correcting codes is used, as in
In Embodiments 1 through 3, the change of phase is applied to precoded baseband signals. However, the amplitude may also be modified along with the phase in order to apply periodical, regular changes. Accordingly, an amplification modification pattern regularly modifying the amplitude of the modulated signals may also be made to conform to Table 1. In such circumstances, the transmission device should include an amplification modifier that modifies the amplification after weighting unit 308A or weighting unit 308B from
Furthermore, although not indicated in Table 1 above, the mapping scheme may also be regularly modified by the mapper, without a regular change of phase.
That is, when the mapping method for modulated signal s1(t) is 16-QAM and the mapping method for modulated signal s2(t) is also 16-QAM, the mapping method applied to modulated signal s2(t) may be regularly changed as follows: from 16-QAM to 16-APSK, to 16-QAM in the I-Q plane, to a first mapping method producing signal point distribution unlike 16-APSK, to 16-QAM in the I-Q plane, to a second mapping method producing signal point distribution unlike 16-APSK, and so on. As such, the data reception quality can be improved for the reception device, much like the results obtained by a regular change of phase described above.
In addition, the present invention may use any combination of methods for a regular change of phase, mapping method, and amplitude, and the transmit signal may transmit with all of these taken into consideration.
The present Embodiment may be realized using single-carrier methods as well as multi-carrier methods. Accordingly, the present Embodiment may also be realized using, for example, spread-spectrum communications, OFDM, SC-FDM, SC-OFDM, wavelet OFDM as described in Non-Patent Literature 7, and so on. As described above, the present Embodiment describes changing the phase, amplitude, and mapping methods by performing phase, amplitude, and mapping method modifications with respect to the time domain t. However, much like Embodiment 1, the same changes may be carried out with respect to the frequency domain. That is, considering the phase, amplitude, and mapping method modification in the time domain t described in the present Embodiment and replacing t with f (f being the ((sub-)carrier) frequency) leads to phase, amplitude, and mapping method modification applicable to the frequency domain. Also, the phase, amplitude, and mapping method modification of the present Embodiment is also applicable to phase, amplitude, and mapping method modification in both the time domain and the frequency domain.
Furthermore, in the present Embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, etc) or symbols transmitting control information, may be arranged within the frame in any manner.
The present Embodiment describes a method of regularly changing the phase when encoding is performed using block codes as described in Non-Patent Literature 12 through 15, such as QC (Quasi-Cyclic) LDPC Codes (not only QC-LDPC but also LDPC codes may be used), concatenated LDPC and BCH (Bose-Chaudhuri-Hocquenghem) codes, Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, and so on. The following example considers a case where two streams s1 and s2 are transmitted. When encoding has been performed using block codes and control information and the like is not necessary, the number of bits making up each coded block matches the number of bits making up each block code (control information and so on described below may yet be included). When encoding has been performed using block codes or the like and control information or the like (e.g., CRC transmission parameters) is required, then the number of bits making up each coded block is the sum of the number of bits making up the block codes and the number of bits making up the information.
As shown in
Then, given that the transmission device from
By the same reasoning, when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, 750 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up each coded block, and when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, 500 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up each coded block.
The following describes the relationship between the above-defined slots and the phase of multiplication, as pertains to methods for a regular change of phase.
Here, five different phase changing values (or phase changing sets) are assumed as having been prepared for use in the method for a regular change of phase. That is, five different phase changing values (or phase changing sets) have been prepared for the phase changer of the transmission device from
For the above-described 1500 slots needed to transmit the 6000 bits making up a single coded block when the modulation scheme is QPSK, PHASE[0] is used on 300 slots, PHASE[1] is used on 300 slots, PHASE[2] is used on 300 slots, PHASE[3] is used on 300 slots, and PHASE[4] is used on 300 slots. This is due to the fact that any bias in phase usage causes great influence to be exerted by the more frequently used phase, and that the reception device is dependent on such influence for data reception quality.
Further still, for the above-described 500 slots needed to transmit the 6000 bits making up a single coded block when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, PHASE[0] is used on 150 slots, PHASE[1] is used on 150 slots, PHASE[2] is used on 150 slots, PHASE[3] is used on 150 slots, and PHASE[4] is used on 150 slots.
Further still, for the above-described 500 slots needed to transmit the 6000 bits making up a single coded block when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, PHASE[0] is used on 100 slots, PHASE[1] is used on 100 slots, PHASE[2] is used on 100 slots, PHASE[3] is used on 100 slots, and PHASE[4] is used on 100 slots.
As described above, a method for a regular change of phase requires the preparation of N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) (where the N different phases are expressed as PHASE[0], PHASE[1], PHASE[2] . . . PHASE[N−2], PHASE[N−1]). As such, in order to transmit all of the bits making up a single coded block, PHASE[0] is used on K0 slots, PHASE[1] is used on K1 slots, PHASE[i] is used on Ki slots (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1), and PHASE[N−1] is used on KN-1 slots, such that Condition #A01 is met.
(Condition #A01)
K0=K1 . . . =Ki= . . . KN-1. That is, Ka=Kb (∀a and ∀b where a, b,=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1; (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b).
Then, when a communication system that supports multiple modulation schemes selects one such supported modulation scheme for use, Condition #A01 is met for the supported modulation scheme.
However, when multiple modulation schemes are supported, each such modulation scheme typically uses symbols transmitting a different number of bits per symbols (though some may happen to use the same number), Condition #A01 may not be satisfied for some modulation schemes. In such a case, the following condition applies instead of Condition #A01.
(Condition #A02)
The difference between Ka and Kb is 0 or 1. That is, |Ka−Kb| is 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b)
As shown in
The transmission device from
By the same reasoning, when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, 1500 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up the two coded blocks, and when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, 1000 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up the two coded blocks
The following describes the relationship between the above-defined slots and the phase of multiplication, as pertains to methods for a regular change of phase.
Here, five different phase changing values (or phase changing sets) are assumed as having been prepared for use in the method for a regular change of phase. That is, five different phase changing values (or phase changing sets) have been prepared for the phase changer of the transmission device from
For the above-described 3000 slots needed to transmit the 6000×2 bits making up the two coded blocks when the modulation scheme is QPSK, PHASE[0] is used on 600 slots, PHASE[1] is used on 600 slots, PHASE[2] is used on 600 slots, PHASE[3] is used on 600 slots, and PHASE[4] is used on 600 slots. This is due to the fact that any bias in phase usage causes great influence to be exerted by the more frequently used phase, and that the reception device is dependent on such influence for data reception quality.
Furthermore, in order to transmit the first coded block, PHASE[0] is used on slots 600 times, PHASE[1] is used on slots 600 times, PHASE[2] is used on slots 600 times, PHASE[3] is used on slots 600 times, and PHASE[4] is used on slots 600 times. Furthermore, in order to transmit the second coded block, PHASE[0] is used on slots 600 times, PHASE[1] is used on slots 600 times, PHASE[2] is used on slots 600 times, PHASE[3] is used on slots 600 times, and PHASE[4] is used on slots 600 times.
Similarly, for the above-described 1500 slots needed to transmit the 6000×2 bits making up the two coded blocks when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, PHASE[0] is used on 300 slots, PHASE[1] is used on 300 slots, PHASE[2] is used on 300 slots, PHASE[3] is used on 300 slots, and PHASE[4] is used on 300 slots.
Furthermore, in order to transmit the first coded block, PHASE[0] is used on slots 300 times, PHASE[1] is used on slots 300 times, PHASE[2] is used on slots 300 times, PHASE[3] is used on slots 300 times, and PHASE[4] is used on slots 300 times. Furthermore, in order to transmit the second coded block, PHASE[0] is used on slots 300 times, PHASE[1] is used on slots 300 times, PHASE[2] is used on slots 300 times, PHASE[3] is used on slots 300 times, and PHASE[4] is used on slots 300 times.
Similarly, for the above-described 1000 slots needed to transmit the 6000×2 bits making up the two coded blocks when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, PHASE[0] is used on 200 slots, PHASE[1] is used on 200 slots, PHASE[2] is used on 200 slots, PHASE[3] is used on 200 slots, and PHASE[4] is used on 200 slots.
Furthermore, in order to transmit the first coded block, PHASE[0] is used on slots 200 times, PHASE[1] is used on slots 200 times, PHASE[2] is used on slots 200 times, PHASE[3] is used on slots 200 times, and PHASE[4] is used on slots 200 times. Furthermore, in order to transmit the second coded block, PHASE[0] is used on slots 200 times, PHASE[1] is used on slots 200 times, PHASE[2] is used on slots 200 times, PHASE[3] is used on slots 200 times, and PHASE[4] is used on slots 200 times.
As described above, a method for regularly changing the phase requires the preparation of phase changing values (or phase changing sets) expressed as PHASE[0], PHASE[1], PHASE[2] . . . PHASE[N−2], PHASE[N−1]. As such, in order to transmit all of the bits making up two coded blocks, PHASE[0] is used on K0 slots, PHASE[1] is used on K1 slots, PHASE[i] is used on Ki slots (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1), and PHASE[N−1] is used on KN-1 slots, such that Condition #A03 is met.
(Condition #A03)
K0=K1 . . . =Ki= . . . KN-1. That is, Ka=Kb (∀a and ∀b where a, b,=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b).
Further, in order to transmit all of the bits making up the first coded block, PHASE[0] is used K0,1 times, PHASE[1] is used K1,1 times, PHASE[i] is used Ki,1 times (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1), and PHASE[N−1] is used KN-1,1 times, such that Condition #A04 is met.
(Condition #A04)
K0,i=K1,1= . . . Ki,1= . . . KN-1,1. That is, Ka,1=Kb,1 (∀a and ∀b where a, b,=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b).
Furthermore, in order to transmit all of the bits making up the second coded block, PHASE[0] is used K0,2 times, PHASE[1] is used K1,2 times, PHASE[i] is used Ki,2 times (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1), and PHASE[N−1] is used KN-1,2 times, such that Condition #A05 is met.
(Condition #A05)
K0,2=K1,2= . . . Ki,2= . . . KN-1,2. That is, Ka,2=Kb,2 (∀a and ∀b where a, b, =0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b).
Then, when a communication system that supports multiple modulation schemes selects one such supported modulation scheme for use, Condition #A03, #A04, and #A05 is met for the supported modulation scheme.
However, when multiple modulation schemes are supported, each such modulation scheme typically uses symbols transmitting a different number of bits per symbol (though some may happen to use the same number), Conditions #A03, #A04, and #A05 may not be satisfied for some modulation schemes. In such a case, the following conditions apply instead of Condition #A03, #A04, and #A05.
(Condition #A06)
The difference between Ka and Kb satisfies 0 or 1. That is, |Ka−Kb| satisfies 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b)
(Condition #A07)
The difference between Ka,1 and Kb,1 satisfies 0 or 1. That is, |Ka,1−Kb,1| satisfies 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b)
(Condition #A08)
The difference between Ka,2 and Kb,2 satisfies 0 or 1. That is, |Ka,2−Kb,2| satisfies 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b)
As described above, bias among the phases being used to transmit the coded blocks is removed by creating a relationship between the coded block and the phase of multiplication. As such, data reception quality may be improved for the reception device.
In the present Embodiment, N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) are needed in order to perform a change of phase having a period (cycle) of N with the method for a regular change of phase. As such, N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) PHASE[0], PHASE[1], PHASE[2] . . . PHASE[N−2], and PHASE[N−1] are prepared. However, schemes exist for reordering the phases in the stated order with respect to the frequency domain. No limitation is intended in this regard. The N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) may also change the phases of blocks in the time domain or in the time-frequency domain to obtain a symbol arrangement as described in Embodiment 1. Although the above examples discuss a phase changing method with a period (cycle) of N, the same effects are obtainable using N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) at random. That is, the N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) need not always have regular periodicity. As long as the above-described conditions are satisfied, great quality data reception improvements are realizable for the reception device.
Furthermore, given the existence of modes for spatial multiplexing MIMO schemes, MIMO schemes using a fixed precoding matrix, space-time block coding schemes, single-stream transmission, and schemes using a regular change of phase (the transmission schemes described in Embodiments 1 through 4), the transmission device (broadcaster, base station) may select any one of these transmission schemes.
As described in Non-Patent Literature 3, spatial multiplexing MIMO methods involve transmitting signals s1 and s2, which are mapped using a selected modulation scheme, on each of two different antennas. As described in Embodiments 1 through 4, MIMO methods using a fixed precoding matrix involve performing precoding only (with no change of phase). Further, space-time block coding methods are described in Non-Patent Literature 9, 16, and 17. Single-stream transmission methods involve transmitting signal s1, mapped with a selected modulation scheme, from an antenna after performing predetermined processing.
Schemes using multi-carrier transmission such as OFDM involve a first carrier group made up of a plurality of carriers and a second carrier group made up of a plurality of carriers different from the first carrier group, and so on, such that multi-carrier transmission is realized with a plurality of carrier groups. For each carrier group, any of spatial multiplexing MIMO schemes, MIMO schemes using a fixed precoding matrix, space-time block coding schemes, single-stream transmission, and schemes using a regular change of phase may be used. In particular, schemes using a regular change of phase on a selected (sub-)carrier group are preferably used to realize the present Embodiment.
When a change of phase is performed, then for example, a phase changing value for PHASE[i] of X radians is performed on only one precoded baseband signal, the phase changers of
The following describes a sample configuration of an application of the transmission methods and reception methods discussed in the above embodiments and a system using the application.
The signals transmitted by the broadcaster 3601 are received by an antenna (such as antenna 3660 or 3640) embedded within or externally connected to each of the receivers. Each receiver obtains the multiplexed data by using reception methods discussed in the above-described Embodiments to demodulate the signals received by the antenna. Accordingly, the digital broadcasting system 3600 is able to realize the effects of the present invention, as discussed in the above-described Embodiments.
The video data included in the multiplexed data are coded with a video coding method compliant with a standard such as MPEG-2 (Moving Picture Experts Group), MPEG4-AVC (Advanced Video Coding), VC-1, or the like. The audio data included in the multiplexed data are encoded with an audio coding method compliant with a standard such as Dolby AC-3 (Audio Coding), Dolby Digital Plus, MLP (Meridian Lossless Packing), DTS (Digital Theatre Systems), DTS-HD, Linear PCM (Pulse-Code Modulation), or the like.
The receiver 3700 further includes a stream interface 3720 that demultiplexes the audio and video data in the multiplexed data obtained by the demodulator 3702, a signal processor 3704 that decodes the video data obtained from the demultiplexed video data into a video signal by applying a video decoding method corresponding thereto and decodes the audio data obtained from the demultiplexed audio data into an audio signal by applying an audio decoding method corresponding thereto, an audio output unit 3706 that outputs the decoded audio signal through a speaker or the like, and a video display unit 3707 that outputs the decoded video signal on a display or the like.
When, for example, a user uses a remote control 3750, information for a selected channel (selected (television) program or audio broadcast) is transmitted to an operation input unit 3710. Then, the receiver 3700 performs processing on the received signal received by the antenna 3760 that includes demodulating the signal corresponding to the selected channel, performing error-correcting decoding, and so on, in order to obtain the received data. At this point, the receiver 3700 obtains control symbol information that includes information on the transmission method (the transmission method, modulation scheme, error-correction method, and so on from the above-described Embodiments) (as described using
According to this configuration, the user is able to view programs received by the receiver 3700.
The receiver 3700 pertaining to the present Embodiment further includes a drive 3708 that may be a magnetic disk, an optical disc, a non-volatile semiconductor memory, or a similar recording medium. The receiver 3700 stores data included in the demultiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding (in some circumstances, the data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 may not be subject to error correction. Also, the receiver 3700 may perform further processing after error correction. The same hereinafter applies to similar statements concerning other components), data corresponding to such data (e.g., data obtained through compression of such data), data obtained through audio and video processing, and so on, on the drive 3708. Here, an optical disc is a recording medium, such as DVD (Digital Versatile Disc) or BD (Blu-ray Disc), that is readable and writable with the use of a laser beam. A magnetic disk is a floppy disk, a hard disk, or similar recording medium on which information is storable through the use of magnetic flux to magnetize a magnetic body. A non-volatile semiconductor memory is a recording medium, such as flash memory or ferroelectric random access memory, composed of semiconductor element(s). Specific examples of non-volatile semiconductor memory include an SD card using flash memory and a Flash SSD (Solid State Drive). Naturally, the specific types of recording media mentioned herein are merely examples. Other types of recording mediums may also be used.
According to this structure, the user is able to record and store programs received by the receiver 3700, and is thereby able to view programs at any given time after broadcasting by reading out the recorded data thereof.
Although the above explanations describe the receiver 3700 storing multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding on the drive 3708, a portion of the data included in the multiplexed data may instead be extracted and recorded. For example, when data broadcasting services or similar content is included along with the audio and video data in the multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding, the audio and video data may be extracted from the multiplexed data demodulated by the demodulator 3702 and stored as new multiplexed data. Furthermore, the drive 3708 may store either the audio data or the video data included in the multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding as new multiplexed data. The aforementioned data broadcasting service content included in the multiplexed data may also be stored on the drive 3708.
Furthermore, when a television, recording device (e.g., a DVD recorder, BD recorder HDD recorder, SD card, or similar), or mobile phone incorporating the receiver 3700 of the present invention receives multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding that includes data for correcting bugs in software used to operate the television or recording device, for correcting bugs in software for preventing personal information and recorded data from being leaked, and so on, such software bugs may be corrected by installing the data on the television or recording device. As such, bugs in the receiver 3700 are corrected through the inclusion of data for correcting bugs in the software of the receiver 3700. Accordingly, the television, recording device, or mobile phone incorporating the receiver 3700 may be made to operate more reliably.
Here, the process of extracting a portion of the data included in the multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding is performed by, for example, the stream interface 3703. Specifically, the stream interface 3703, demultiplexes the various data included in the multiplexed data demodulated by the demodulator 3702, such as audio data, video data, data broadcasting service content, and so on, as instructed by a non-diagrammed controller such as a CPU. The stream interface 3703 then extracts and multiplexes only the indicated demultiplexed data, thus generating new multiplexed data. The data to be extracted from the demultiplexed data may be determined by the user or may be determined in advance according to the type of recording medium.
According to such a structure, the receiver 3700 is able to extract and record only the data needed in order to view the recorded program. As such, the amount of data to be recorded can be reduced.
Although the above explanation describes the drive 3708 as storing multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding, the video data included in the multiplexed data so obtained may be converted by using a different video coding method than the original video coding method applied thereto, so as to reduce the amount of data or the bit rate thereof. The drive 3708 may then store the converted video data as new multiplexed data. Here, the video coding method used to generate the new video data may conform to a different standard than that used to generate the original video data. Alternatively, the same video coding method may be used with different parameters. Similarly, the audio data included in the multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding may be converted by using a different audio coding method than the original audio coding method applied thereto, so as to reduce the amount of data or the bit rate thereof. The drive 3708 may then store the converted audio data as new multiplexed data.
Here, the process by which the audio or video data included in the multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding is converted so as to reduce the amount of data or the bit rate thereof is performed by, for example, the stream interface 3703 or the signal processor 3704. Specifically, the stream interface 3703 demultiplexes the various data included in the multiplexed data demodulated by the demodulator 3702, such as audio data, video data, data broadcasting service content, and so on, as instructed by an undiagrammed controller such as a CPU. The signal processor 3704 then performs processing to convert the video data so demultiplexed by using a different video coding method than the original video coding method applied thereto, and performs processing to convert the audio data so demultiplexed by using a different video coding method than the original audio coding method applied thereto. As instructed by the controller, the stream interface 3703 then multiplexes the converted audio and video data, thus generating new multiplexed data. The signal processor 3704 may, in accordance with instructions from the controller, performing conversion processing on either the video data or the audio data, alone, or may perform conversion processing on both types of data. In addition, the amounts of video data and audio data or the bit rate thereof to be obtained by conversion may be specified by the user or determined in advance according to the type of recording medium.
According to such a structure, the receiver 3700 is able to modify the amount of data or the bitrate of the audio and video data for storage according to the data storage capacity of the recording medium, or according to the data reading or writing speed of the drive 3708. Therefore, programs can be stored on the drive despite the storage capacity of the recording medium being less than the amount of multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding, or the data reading or writing speed of the drive being lower than the bit rate of the demultiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702. As such, the user is able to view programs at any given time after broadcasting by reading out the recorded data.
The receiver 3700 further includes a stream output interface 3709 that transmits the multiplexed data demultiplexed by the demodulator 3702 to external devices through a communications medium 3730. The stream output interface 3709 may be, for example, a wireless communication device transmitting modulated multiplexed data to an external device using a wireless transmission method conforming to a wireless communication standard such as Wi-Fi™ (IEEE 802.11a, IEEE 802.11b, IEEE 802.11g, IEEE 802.11n, and so on), WiGiG, WirelessHD, Bluetooth™, ZigBee™, and so on through a wireless medium (corresponding to the communications medium 3730). The stream output interface 3709 may also be a wired communication device transmitting modulated multiplexed data to an external device using a communication method conforming to a wired communication standard such as Ethernet™, USB (Universal Serial Bus), PLC (Power Line Communication), HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) and so on through a wired transmission path (corresponding to the communications medium 3730) connected to the stream output interface 3709.
According to this configuration, the user is able to use an external device with the multiplexed data received by the receiver 3700 using the reception method described in the above-described Embodiments. The usage of multiplexed data by the user here includes use of the multiplexed data for real-time viewing on an external device, recording of the multiplexed data by a recording unit included in an external device, and transmission of the multiplexed data from an external device to a yet another external device.
Although the above explanations describe the receiver 3700 outputting multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding through the stream output interface 3709, a portion of the data included in the multiplexed data may instead be extracted and output. For example, when data broadcasting services or similar content is included along with the audio and video data in the multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding, the audio and video data may be extracted from the multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding, multiplexed and output by the stream output interface 3709 as new multiplexed data. In addition, the stream output interface 3709 may store either the audio data or the video data included in the multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding as new multiplexed data.
Here, the process of extracting a portion of the data included in the multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding is performed by, for example, the stream interface 3703. Specifically, the stream interface 3703 demultiplexes the various data included in the multiplexed data demodulated by the demodulator 3702, such as audio data, video data, data broadcasting service content, and so on, as instructed by an undiagrammed controller such as a CPU. The stream interface 3703 then extracts and multiplexes only the indicated demultiplexed data, thus generating new multiplexed data. The data to be extracted from the demultiplexed data may be determined by the user or may be determined in advance according to the type of stream output interface 3709.
According to this structure, the receiver 3700 is able to extract and output only the required data to an external device. As such, fewer multiplexed data are output using less communication bandwidth.
Although the above explanation describes the stream output interface 3709 as outputting multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding, the video data included in the multiplexed data so obtained may be converted by using a different video coding method than the original video coding method applied thereto, so as to reduce the amount of data or the bit rate thereof. The stream output interface 3709 may then output the converted video data as new multiplexed data. Here, the video coding method used to generate the new video data may conform to a different standard than that used to generate the original video data. Alternatively, the same video coding method may be used with different parameters. Similarly, the audio data included in the multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding may be converted by using a different audio coding method than the original audio coding method applied thereto, so as to reduce the amount of data or the bit rate thereof. The stream output interface 3709 may then output the converted audio data as new multiplexed data.
Here, the process by which the audio or video data included in the multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding is converted so as to reduce the amount of data or the bit rate thereof is performed by, for example, the stream interface 3703 or the signal processor 3704. Specifically, the stream interface 3703 demultiplexes the various data included in the multiplexed data demodulated by the demodulator 3702, such as audio data, video data, data broadcasting service content, and so on, as instructed by an undiagrammed controller. The signal processor 3704 then performs processing to convert the video data so demultiplexed by using a different video coding method than the original video coding method applied thereto, and performs processing to convert the audio data so demultiplexed by using a different video coding method than the original audio coding method applied thereto. As instructed by the controller, the stream interface 3703 then multiplexes the converted audio and video data, thus generating new multiplexed data. The signal processor 3704 may, in accordance with instructions from the controller, performing conversion processing on either the video data or the audio data, alone, or may perform conversion processing on both types of data. In addition, the amounts of video data and audio data or the bit rate thereof to be obtained by conversion may be specified by the user or determined in advance according to the type of stream output interface 3709.
According to this structure, the receiver 3700 is able to modify the bit rate of the video and audio data for output according to the speed of communication with the external device. Thus, despite the speed of communication with an external device being slower than the bit rate of the multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding, by outputting new multiplexed data from the stream output interface to the external device, the user is able to use the new multiplexed data with other communication devices.
The receiver 3700 further includes an audiovisual output interface 3711 that outputs audio and video signals decoded by the signal processor 3704 to the external device through an external communications medium. The audiovisual output interface 3711 may be, for example, a wireless communication device transmitting modulated audiovisual data to an external device using a wireless transmission method conforming to a wireless communication standard such as Wi-Fi™ (IEEE 802.11a, IEEE 802.11b, IEEE 802.11g, IEEE 802.11n, and so on), WiGig, WirelessHD, Bluetooth™, ZigBee™, and so on through a wireless medium. The stream output interface 3709 may also be a wired communication device transmitting modulated audiovisual data to an external device using a communication method conforming to a wired communication standard such as Ethernet™, USB, PLC, HDMI, and so on through a wired transmission path connected to the stream output interface 3709. Furthermore, the stream output interface 3709 may be a terminal for connecting a cable that outputs analogue audio signals and video signals as-is.
According to such a structure, the user is able to use the audio signals and video signals decoded by the signal processor 3704 with an external device.
Further, the receiver 3700 includes an operation input unit 3710 that receives user operations as input. The receiver 3700 behaves in accordance with control signals input by the operation input unit 3710 according to user operations, such as by switching the power supply ON or OFF, changing the channel being received, switching subtitle display ON or OFF, switching between languages, changing the volume output by the audio output unit 3706, and various other operations, including modifying the settings for receivable channels and the like.
The receiver 3700 may further include functionality for displaying an antenna level representing the received signal quality while the receiver 3700 is receiving a signal. The antenna level may be, for example, a index displaying the received signal quality calculated according to the RSSI (Received Signal Strength Indicator), the received signal magnetic field strength, the C/N (carrier-to-noise) ratio, the BER, the packet error rate, the frame error rate, the channel state information, and so on, received by the receiver 3700 and indicating the level and the quality of a received signal. In such circumstances, the demodulator 3702 includes a signal quality calibrator that measures the RSSI, the received signal magnetic field strength, the C/N ratio, the BER, the packet error rate, the frame error rate, the channel state information, and so on. In response to user operations, the receiver 3700 displays the antenna level (signal level, signal quality) in a user-recognizable format on the video display unit 3707. The display format for the antenna level (signal level, signal quality) may be a numerical value displayed according to the RSSI, the received signal magnetic field strength, the C/N ratio, the BER, the packet error rate, the frame error rate, the channel state information, and so on, or may be an image display that varies according to the RSSI, the received signal magnetic field strength, the C/N ratio, the BER, the packet error rate, the frame error rate, the channel state information, and so on. The receiver 3700 may display multiple antenna level (signal level, signal quality) calculated for each stream s1, s2, and so on demultiplexed using the reception method discussed in the above-described Embodiments, or may display a single antenna level (signal level, signal quality) calculated for all such streams. When the video data and audio data composing a program are transmitted hierarchically, the signal level (signal quality) may also be displayed for each hierarchical level.
According to the above structure, the user is given an understanding of the antenna level (signal level, signal quality) numerically or visually during reception using the reception methods discussed in the above-described Embodiments.
Although the above example describes the receiver 3700 as including the audio output unit 3706, the video display unit 3707, the drive 3708, the stream output interface 3709, and the audiovisual output interface 3711, all of these components are not strictly necessary. As long as the receiver 3700 includes at least one of the above-described components, the user is able to use the multiplexed data obtained through demodulation by the demodulator 3702 and error-correcting decoding. Any receiver may be freely combined with the above-described components according to the usage method.
(Multiplexed Data)
The following is a detailed description of a sample configuration of multiplexed data. The data configuration typically used in broadcasting is an MPEG-2 transport stream (TS). Therefore the following description describes an example related to MPEG2-TS. However, the data configuration of the multiplexed data transmitted by the transmission and reception methods discussed in the above-described Embodiments is not limited to MPEG2-TS. The advantageous effects of the above-described Embodiments are also achievable using any other data structure.
Each stream included in the multiplexed data is identified by an identifier, termed a PID, uniquely assigned to the stream. For example, PID 0x1011 is assigned to the video stream used for the main video of the movie, PIDs 0x1100 through 0x111F are assigned to the audio streams, PIDs 0x1200 through 0x121F are assigned to the presentation graphics, PIDs 0x1400 through 0x141F are assigned to the interactive graphics, PIDs 0x1B00 through 0x1B1F are assigned to the video streams used for the sub-video of the movie, and PIDs 0x1A00 through 0x1A1F are assigned to the audio streams used as sub-audio to be mixed with the main audio of the movie.
In addition to the video streams, audio streams, presentation graphics streams, and the like, the TS packets included in the multiplexed data also include a PAT (Program Association Table), a PMT (Program Map Table), a PCR (Program Clock Reference) and so on. The PAT indicates the PID of a PMT used in the multiplexed data, and the PID of the PAT itself is registered as 0. The PMT includes PIDs identifying the respective streams, such as video, audio and subtitles, contained in the multiplexed data and attribute information (frame rate, aspect ratio, and the like) of the streams identified by the respective PIDs. In addition, the PMT includes various types of descriptors relating to the multiplexed data. One such descriptor may be copy control information indicating whether or not copying of the multiplexed data is permitted. The PCR includes information for synchronizing the ATC (Arrival Time Clock) serving as the chronological axis of the ATS to the STC (System Time Clock) serving as the chronological axis of the PTS and DTS. Each PCR packet includes an STC time corresponding to the ATS at which the packet is to be transferred to the decoder.
When recorded onto a recoding medium or the like, the multiplexed data are recorded along with a multiplexed data information file.
The multiplexed data information is made up of a system rate, a playback start time, and a playback end time. The system rate indicates the maximum transfer rate of the multiplexed data to the PID filter of a later-described system target decoder. The multiplexed data includes ATS at an interval set so as not to exceed the system rate. The playback start time is set to the time specified by the PTS of the first video frame in the multiplexed data, whereas the playback end time is set to the time calculated by adding the playback duration of one frame to the PTS of the last video frame in the multiplexed data.
In the present Embodiment, the stream type included in the PMT is used among the information included in the multiplexed data. When the multiplexed data are recorded on a recording medium, the video stream attribute information included in the multiplexed data information file is used. Specifically, the video coding method and device described in any of the above Embodiments may be modified to additionally include a step or unit of setting a specific piece of information in the stream type included in the PMT or in the video stream attribute information. The specific piece of information is for indicating that the video data are generated by the video coding method and device described in the Embodiment. According to such a structure, video data generated by the video coding method and device described in any of the above Embodiments is distinguishable from video data compliant with other standards.
In addition, the audiovisual output device 4500 may be operated using the Internet. For example, the audiovisual output device 4500 may be made to record (store) a program through another terminal connected to the Internet. (Accordingly, the audiovisual output device 4500 should include the drive 3708 from
(Supplement)
The present description considers a communications/broadcasting device such as a broadcaster, a base station, an access point, a terminal, a mobile phone, or the like provided with the transmission device, and a communications device such as a television, radio, terminal, personal computer, mobile phone, access point, base station, or the like provided with the reception device. The transmission device and the reception device pertaining to the present invention are communication devices in a form able to execute applications, such as a television, radio, personal computer, mobile phone, or similar, through connection to some sort of interface (e.g., USB).
Furthermore, in the present Embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (namely preamble, unique word, postamble, reference symbols, scattered pilot symbols and so on), symbols intended for control information, and so on may be freely arranged within the frame. Although pilot symbols and symbols intended for control information are presently named, such symbols may be freely named otherwise as the function thereof remains the important consideration.
Provided that a pilot symbol, for example, is a known symbol modulated with PSK modulation in the transmitter and receiver (alternatively, the receiver may be synchronized such that the receiver knows the symbols transmitted by the transmitter), the receiver is able to use this symbol for frequency synchronization, time synchronization, channel estimation (CSI (Channel State Information) estimation for each modulated signal), signal detection, and the like.
The symbols intended for control information are symbols transmitting information (such as the modulation scheme, error-correcting coding method, coding rate of error-correcting codes, and setting information for the top layer used in communications) that is transmitted to the receiving party in order to execute transmission of non-data (i.e., applications).
The present invention is not limited to the Embodiments, but may also be realized in various other ways. For example, while the above Embodiments describe communication devices, the present invention is not limited to such devices and may be implemented as software for the corresponding communications method.
Although the above-described Embodiments describe phase changing methods for methods of transmitting two modulated signals from two antennas, no limitation is intended in this regard. Precoding and a change of phase may be performed on four signals that have been mapped to generate four modulated signals transmitted using four antennas. That is, the present invention is applicable to performing a change of phase on N signals that have been mapped and precoded to generate N modulated signals transmitted using N antennas.
Although the above-described Embodiments describe examples of systems where two modulated signals are transmitted from two antennas and received by two respective antennas in a MIMO communications system, the present invention is not limited in this regard and is also applicable to MISO (Multiple Input Single Output) communications systems. In a MISO system, the reception device does not include antenna 701_Y, wireless unit 703_Y, channel fluctuation estimator 707_1 for modulated signal z1, and channel fluctuation estimator 707_2 for modulated signal z2 from
Although the present invention describes examples of systems where two modulated signals are transmitted from two antennas and received by two respective antennas in a MIMO communications system, the present invention is not limited in this regard and is also applicable to MISO systems. In a MISO system, the transmission device performs precoding and change of phase such that the points described thus far are applicable. However, the reception device does not include antenna 701_Y, wireless unit 703_Y, channel fluctuation estimator 707_1 for modulated signal z1, and channel fluctuation estimator 707_2 for modulated signal z2 from
The present description uses terms such as precoding, precoding weights, precoding matrix, and so on. The terminology itself may be otherwise (e.g., may be alternatively termed a codebook) as the key point of the present invention is the signal processing itself.
Furthermore, although the present description discusses examples mainly using OFDM as the transmission method, the invention is not limited in this manner. Multi-carrier methods other than OFDM and single-carrier methods may all be used to achieve similar Embodiments. Here, spread-spectrum communications may also be used. When single-carrier methods are used, the change of phase is performed with respect to the time domain.
In addition, although the present description discusses the use of ML operations, APP, Max-log APP, ZF, MMSE and so on by the reception device, these operations may all be generalized as wave detection, demodulation, detection, estimation, and demultiplexing as the soft decision results (log-likelihood and log-likelihood ratio) and the hard decision results (zeroes and ones) obtained thereby are the individual bits of data transmitted by the transmission device.
Different data may be transmitted by each stream s1(t) and s2(t) (s1(i), s2(i)), or identical data may be transmitted thereby.
The two stream baseband signals s1(i) and s2(i) (where i indicates sequence (with respect to time or (carrier) frequency)) undergo precoding and a regular change of phase (the order of operations may be freely reversed) to generate two post-processing baseband signals z1(i) and z2(i). For post-processing baseband signal z1(i), the in-phase component I is I1(i) while the quadrature component is Q1(i), and for post processing baseband signal z2(i), the in-phase component is I1(i) while the quadrature component is Q2(i). The baseband components may be switched, as long as the following holds.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i) and Q2(i), and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i) and Q1(i).
The modulated signal corresponding to switched baseband signal r1(i) is transmitted by transmit antenna 1 and the modulated signal corresponding to switched baseband signal r2(i) is transmitted from transmit antenna 2, simultaneously on a common frequency. As such, the modulated signal corresponding to switched baseband signal r1(i) and the modulated signal corresponding to switched baseband signal r2(i) are transmitted from different antennas, simultaneously on a common frequency. Alternatively,
Alternatively, although the above description discusses performing two types of signal processing on both stream signals so as to switch the in-phase component and quadrature component of the two signals, the invention is not limited in this manner. The two types of signal processing may be performed on more than two streams, so as to switch the in-phase component and quadrature component thereof.
Alter, while the above examples describe switching performed on baseband signals having a common timestamp (common (sub-)carrier) frequency), the baseband signals being switched need not necessarily have a common timestamp (common (sub-)carrier) frequency). For example, any of the following are possible.
Each of the transmit antennas of the transmission device and each of the receive antennas of the reception device shown in the figures may be formed by a plurality of antennas.
The present description uses the symbol ∀, which is the universal quantifier, and the symbol ∃, which is the existential quantifier.
Furthermore, the present description uses the radian as the unit of phase in the complex plane, e.g., for the argument thereof.
When dealing with the complex plane, the coordinates of complex numbers are expressible by way of polar coordinates. For a complex number z=a+jb (where a and b are real numbers and j is the imaginary unit), the corresponding point (a, b) on the complex plane is expressed with the polar coordinates [r, θ], converted as follows:
a=r×cos θ
b=r×sin θ
[Math. 49]
r=√{square root over (a2+b2)} (formula 49)
where r is the absolute value of z(r=|z|), and θ is the argument thereof. As such, z=a+jb is expressible as rejθ.
In the present invention, the baseband signals s1, s2, z1, and z2 are described as being complex signals. A complex signal made up of in-phase signal I and quadrature signal Q is also expressible as complex signal I+jQ. Here, either of I and Q may be equal to zero.
A transmitter 4607 takes the encoded video data 4602, the encoded audio data 4604, and the encoded data 4606 as input, performs error-correcting coding, modulation, precoding, and phase changing (e.g., the signal processing by the transmission device from
A receiver 4612 takes received signals 4611_1 through 4611_M received by antennas 4610_1 through 4610_M as input, performs processing such as frequency conversion, change of phase, decoding of the precoding, log-likelihood ratio calculation, and error-correcting decoding (e.g., the processing by the reception device from
In the above-described Embodiments pertaining to the present invention, the number of encoders in the transmission device using a multi-carrier transmission method such as OFDM may be any number, as described above. Therefore, as in
Although Embodiment 1 gives Math. 36 (formula 36) as an example of a precoding matrix, another precoding matrix may also be used, when the following method is applied.
In the precoding matrices of Math. 36 (formula 36) and Math. 50 (formula 50), the value of α is set as given by Math. 37 (formula 37) and Math. 38 (formula 38). However, no limitation is intended in this manner. A simple precoding matrix is obtainable by setting α=1, which is also a valid value.
In Embodiment A1, the phase changers from
where k=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1 (k being an integer between 0 and N−1). When N=5, 7, 9, 11, or 15, the reception device is able to obtain good data reception quality.
Although the present description discusses the details of phase changing methods involving two modulated signals transmitted by a plurality of antennas, no limitation is intended in this regard. Precoding and a change of phase may be performed on three or more baseband signals on which mapping has been performed according to a modulation scheme, followed by predetermined processing on the post-phase change baseband signals and transmission using a plurality of antennas, to realize the same results.
Programs for executing the above transmission method may, for example, be stored in advance in ROM (Read-Only Memory) and be read out for operation by a CPU.
Furthermore, the programs for executing the above transmission method may be stored on a computer-readable recording medium, the programs stored in the recording medium may be loaded in the RAM (Random Access Memory) of the computer, and the computer may be operated in accordance with the programs.
The components of the above-described Embodiments may be typically assembled as an LSI (Large Scale Integration), a type of integrated circuit. Individual components may respectively be made into discrete chips, or a subset or entirety of the components may be made into a single chip. Although an LSI is mentioned above, the terms IC (Integrated Circuit), system LSI, super LSI, or ultra LSI may also apply, depending on the degree of integration. Furthermore, the method of integrated circuit assembly is not limited to LSI. A dedicated circuit or a general-purpose processor may be used. After LSI assembly, a FPGA (Field Programmable Gate Array) or reconfigurable processor may be used.
Furthermore, should progress in the field of semiconductors or emerging technologies lead to replacement of LSI with other integrated circuit methods, then such technology may of course be used to integrate the functional blocks. Applications to biotechnology are also plausible.
Embodiment 1 explained that the precoding matrix in use may be switched when transmission parameters change. The present Embodiment describes a detailed example of such a case, where, as described above (in the supplement), the transmission parameters change such that streams s1(t) and s2(t) switch between transmitting different data and transmitting identical data, and the precoding matrix and phase changing method being used are switched accordingly.
The example of the present Embodiment describes a situation where two modulated signals transmitted from two different transmit antenna alternate between having the modulated signals include identical data and having the modulated signals each include different data.
On the other hand, when transmitting different data, distributed data 405A are given as x1, x3, x5, x7, x9, and so on, while distributed data 405B are given as x2, x4, x6, x8, x10, and so on.
The distributor 404 determines, according to the frame configuration signal 313 taken as input, whether the transmission mode is identical data transmission or different data transmission.
An alternative method to the above is shown in
One characteristic feature of the present Embodiment is that, when the transmission mode switches from identical data transmission to different data transmission, the precoding matrix may also be switched. As indicated by Math. 36 (formula 36) and Math. 39 (formula 39) in Embodiment 1, given a matrix made up of w11, w12, w21, and w22, the precoding matrix used to transmit identical data may be as follows.
where a is a real number (a may also be a complex number, but given that the baseband signal input as a result of precoding undergoes a change of phase, a real number is preferable for considerations of circuit size and complexity reduction). Also, when a is equal to one, the weighting units 308A and 308B do not perform weighting and output the input signal as-is.
Accordingly, when transmitting identical data, the weighted baseband signals 309A and 316B are identical signals output by the weighting units 308A and 308B.
When the frame configuration signal 313 indicates identical transmission mode, a phase changer 5201 performs a change of phase on weighted baseband signal 309A and outputs post-phase change baseband signal 5202. Similarly, when the frame configuration signal indicates identical transmission mode, phase changer 317B performs a change of phase on weighted baseband signal 316B and outputs post-phase change baseband signal 309B. The change of phase performed by phase changer 5201 is of ejA(t) (alternatively, ejA(f) or ejA(t,f) (where t is time and f is frequency) (accordingly, ejA(t) (alternatively, ejA(t) or ejA(t,f) is the value by which the input baseband signal is multiplied), and the change of phase performed by phase changer 317B is of ejB(t) (alternatively, ejB(f) or ejB(t,f) (where t is time and f is frequency) (accordingly, ejB(t) (alternatively, ejB(f) or ejB(t,f) is the value by which the input baseband signal is multiplied). As such, the following condition is satisfied.
Some time t satisfies
ejA(t)≠ejB(t) [Math. 53]
(Or, some (carrier) frequency f satisfies ejA(f)≠ejB(f))
(Or, some (carrier) frequency f and time t satisfy ejA(t,f)≠ejB(t,f))
As such, the transmit signal is able to reduce multi-path influence and thereby improve data reception quality for the reception device. (However, the change of phase may also be performed by only one of the weighted baseband signals 309A and 316B.)
In
When the selected transmission mode indicates different data transmission, then any of Math. 36 (formula 36), Math. 39 (formula 39), and Math. 50 (formula 50) given in Embodiment 1 may apply. Significantly, the phase changers 5201 and 317B from
When the selected transmission mode indicates different data transmission, the precoding matrix may be as given in Math. 52 (formula 52), or as given in any of Math. 36 (formula 36), Math. 50 (formula 50), and Math. 39 (formula 39), or may be a precoding matrix unlike that given in Math. 52 (formula 52). Thus, the reception device is especially likely to experience improvements to data reception quality in the LOS environment.
Furthermore, although the present Embodiment discusses examples using OFDM as the transmission method, the invention is not limited in this manner. Multi-carrier methods other than OFDM and single-carrier methods may all be used to achieve similar Embodiments. Here, spread-spectrum communications may also be used. When single-carrier methods are used, the change of phase is performed with respect to the time domain.
As explained in Embodiment 3, when the transmission method involves different data transmission, the change of phase is carried out on the data symbols, only. However, as described in the present Embodiment, when the transmission method involves identical data transmission, then the change of phase need not be limited to the data symbols but may also be performed on pilot symbols, control symbols, and other such symbols inserted into the transmission frame of the transmit signal. (The change of phase need not always be performed on symbols such as pilot symbols and control symbols, though doing so is preferable in order to achieve diversity gain.)
The present Embodiment describes a configuration method for a base station corresponding to Embodiment C1.
A terminal Q (5908) receives transmit signal 5903A transmitted by antenna 5904A of base station A (5902A) and transmit signal 593B transmitted by antenna 5904B of base station B (5902B), then performs predetermined processing thereon to obtained received data.
As shown, transmit signals 5903A and 5905A transmitted by base station A (5902A) and transmit signals 5903B and 5905B transmitted by base station B (5902B) use at least frequency band X and frequency band Y. Frequency band X is used to transmit data of a first channel, and frequency band Y is used to transmit data of a second channel.
Accordingly, terminal P (5907) receives transmit signal 5903A transmitted by antenna 5904A and transmit signal 5905A transmitted by antenna 5906A of base station A (5902A), extracts frequency band X therefrom, performs predetermined processing, and thus obtains the data of the first channel. Terminal Q (5908) receives transmit signal 5903A transmitted by antenna 5904A of base station A (5902A) and transmit signal 5903B transmitted by antenna 5904B of base station B (5902B), extracts frequency band Y therefrom, performs predetermined processing, and thus obtains the data of the second channel.
The following describes the configuration and operations of base station A (5902A) and base station B (5902B).
As described in Embodiment C1, both base station A (5902A) and base station B (5902B) incorporate a transmission device configured as illustrated by
The creation of encoded data in frequency band Y may involve, as shown in
Also, in
As explained above, when the base station transmits different data, the precoding matrix and phase changing method are set according to the transmission method to generate modulated signals.
On the other hand, to transmit identical data, two base stations respectively generate and transmit modulated signals. In such circumstances, base stations each generating modulated signals for transmission from a common antenna may be considered to be two combined base stations using the precoding matrix given by Math. 52 (formula 52). The phase changing method is as explained in Embodiment C1, for example, and satisfies the conditions of Math. 53 (formula 53).
In addition, the transmission method of frequency band X and frequency band Y may vary over time. Accordingly, as illustrated in
According to the present Embodiment, not only can the reception device obtain improved data reception quality for identical data transmission as well as different data transmission, but the transmission devices can also share a phase changer.
Furthermore, although the present Embodiment discusses examples using OFDM as the transmission method, the invention is not limited in this manner. Multi-carrier methods other than OFDM and single-carrier methods may all be used to achieve similar Embodiments. Here, spread-spectrum communications may also be used. When single-carrier methods are used, the change of phase is performed with respect to the time domain.
As explained in Embodiment 3, when the transmission method involves different data transmission, the change of phase is carried out on the data symbols, only. However, as described in the present Embodiment, when the transmission method involves identical data transmission, then the change of phase need not be limited to the data symbols but may also be performed on pilot symbols, control symbols, and other such symbols inserted into the transmission frame of the transmit signal. (The change of phase need not always be performed on symbols such as pilot symbols and control symbols, though doing so is preferable in order to achieve diversity gain.)
The present Embodiment describes a configuration method for a repeater corresponding to Embodiment C1. The repeater may also be termed a repeating station.
Repeater A (6203A) performs processing such as demodulation on received signal 6205A received by receive antenna 6204A and on received signal 6207A received by receive antenna 6206A, thus obtaining received data. Then, in order to transmit the received data to a terminal, repeater A (6203A) performs transmission processing to generate modulated signals 6209A and 6211A for transmission on respective antennas 6210A and 6212A.
Similarly, repeater B (6203B) performs processing such as demodulation on received signal 6205B received by receive antenna 6204B and on received signal 6207B received by receive antenna 6206B, thus obtaining received data. Then, in order to transmit the received data to a terminal, repeater B (6203B) performs transmission processing to generate modulated signals 6209B and 6211B for transmission on respective antennas 6210B and 6212B. Here, repeater B (6203B) is a master repeater that outputs a control signal 6208. repeater A (6203A) takes the control signal as input. A master repeater is not strictly necessary. Base station 6201 may also transmit individual control signals to repeater A (6203A) and to repeater B (6203B).
Terminal P (5907) receives modulated signals transmitted by repeater A (6203A), thereby obtaining data. Terminal Q (5908) receives signals transmitted by repeater A (6203A) and by repeater B (6203B), thereby obtaining data. Terminal R (6213) receives modulated signals transmitted by repeater B (6203B), thereby obtaining data.
As shown, the modulated signals transmitted by antenna 6202A and by antenna 6202B use at least frequency band X and frequency band Y. Frequency band X is used to transmit data of a first channel, and frequency band Y is used to transmit data of a second channel.
As described in Embodiment C1, the data of the first channel is transmitted using frequency band X in different data transmission mode. Accordingly, as shown in
As shown in
As shown, modulated signal 6209A transmitted by antenna 6210A and modulated signal 6211A transmitted by antenna 6212A use at least frequency band X and frequency band Y. Also, modulated signal 6209B transmitted by antenna 6210B and modulated signal 6211B transmitted by antenna 6212B similarly use at least frequency band X and frequency band Y. Frequency band X is used to transmit data of a first channel, and frequency band Y is used to transmit data of a second channel.
As described in Embodiment C1, the data of the first channel is transmitted using frequency band X in different data transmission mode. Accordingly, as shown in
As shown in
The following describes the configuration of repeater A (6203A) and repeater B (6203B) from
Receiver 6203X and onward constitute a processor for generating a modulated signal for transmitting frequency band X. Further, the receiver here described is not only the receiver for frequency band X as shown in
The overall operations of the distributor 404 are identical to those of the distributor in the base station described in Embodiment C2.
When transmitting as indicated in
As for frequency band Y, repeater A (6203A) operates a processor 6500 pertaining to frequency band Y and corresponding to the signal processor 6500 pertaining to frequency band X shown in
As shown in
As explained above, when the repeater transmits different data, the precoding matrix and phase changing method are set according to the transmission method to generate modulated signals.
On the other hand, to transmit identical data, two repeaters respectively generate and transmit modulated signals. In such circumstances, repeaters each generating modulated signals for transmission from a common antenna may be considered to be two combined repeaters using the precoding matrix given by Math. 52 (formula 52). The phase changing method is as explained in Embodiment C1, for example, and satisfies the conditions of Math. 53 (formula 53).
Also, as explained in Embodiment C1 for frequency band X, the base station and repeater may each have two antennas that transmit respective modulated signals and two antennas that receive identical data. The operations of such a base station or repeater are as described for Embodiment C1.
According to the present Embodiment, not only can the reception device obtain improved data reception quality for identical data transmission as well as different data transmission, but the transmission devices can also share a phase changer.
Furthermore, although the present Embodiment discusses examples using OFDM as the transmission method, the invention is not limited in this manner. Multi-carrier methods other than OFDM and single-carrier methods may all be used to achieve similar Embodiments. Here, spread-spectrum communications may also be used. When single-carrier methods are used, the change of phase is performed with respect to the time domain.
As explained in Embodiment 3, when the transmission method involves different data transmission, the change of phase is carried out on the data symbols, only. However, as described in the present Embodiment, when the transmission method involves identical data transmission, then the change of phase need not be limited to the data symbols but may also be performed on pilot symbols, control symbols, and other such symbols inserted into the transmission frame of the transmit signal. (The change of phase need not always be performed on symbols such as pilot symbols and control symbols, though doing so is preferable in order to achieve diversity gain.)
The present Embodiment concerns a phase changing method different from the phase changing methods described in Embodiment 1 and in the Supplement.
In Embodiment 1, Math. 36 (formula 36) is given as an example of a precoding matrix, and in the Supplement, Math. 50 (formula 50) is similarly given as another such example. In Embodiment A1, the phase changers from
where k=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1 (k being an integer between 0 and N−1).
Accordingly, the reception device is able to achieve improvements in data reception quality in the LOS environment, and especially in a radio wave propagation environment. In the LOS environment, when the change of phase has not been performed, a regular phase relationship occurs. However, when the change of phase is performed, the phase relationship is modified, in turn avoiding poor conditions in a burst-like propagation environment. As an alternative to Math. 54 (formula 54), PHASE[k] may be calculated as follows.
where k=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1 (k being an integer between 0 and N−1).
As a further alternative phase changing method, PHASE[k] may be calculated as follows.
where k=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1 (k being an integer between 0 and N−1).
As a further alternative phase changing method, PHASE[k] may be calculated as follows.
where k=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1 (k being an integer between 0 and N−1).
As such, by performing the change of phase according to the present Embodiment, the reception device is made more likely to obtain good reception quality.
The change of phase of the present Embodiment is applicable not only to single-carrier methods but also to multi-carrier methods. Accordingly, the present Embodiment may also be realized using, for example, spread-spectrum communications, OFDM, SC-FDMA, SC-OFDM, wavelet OFDM as described in Non-Patent Literature 7, and so on. As previously described, while the present Embodiment explains the change of phase as a change of phase with respect to the time domain t, the phase may alternatively be changed with respect to the frequency domain as described in Embodiment 1. That is, considering the change of phase with respect to the time domain t described in the present Embodiment and replacing t with f (f being the ((sub-)carrier) frequency) leads to a change of phase applicable to the frequency domain. Also, as explained above for Embodiment 1, the phase changing method of the present Embodiment is also applicable to a change of phase with respect to both the time domain and the frequency domain. Further, when the phase changing method described in the present Embodiment satisfies the conditions indicated in Embodiment A1, the reception device is highly likely to obtain good data quality.
The present Embodiment concerns a phase changing method different from the phase changing methods described in Embodiment 1, in the Supplement, and in Embodiment C4.
In Embodiment 1, Math. 36 (formula 36) is given as an example of a precoding matrix, and in the Supplement, Math. 50 (formula 50) is similarly given as another such example. In Embodiment A1, the phase changers from
The characteristic feature of the phase changing method pertaining to the present Embodiment is the period (cycle) of N=2n+1. To achieve the period (cycle) of N=2n+1, n+1 different phase changing values are prepared. Among these n+1 different phase changing values, n phase changing values are used twice per period (cycle), and one phase changing value is used only once per period (cycle), thus achieving the period (cycle) of N=2n+1. The following describes these phase changing values in detail.
The n+1 different phase changing values required to achieve a phase changing method in which the phase changing value is regularly switched in a period (cycle) of N=2n+1 are expressed as PHASE[0], PHASE[1], PHASE[i] . . . PHASE[n−1], PHASE[n] (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . n−2, n−1, n (i being an integer between 0 and n)). Here, the n+1 different phase changing values of PHASE[0], PHASE[1], PHASE[i] . . . PHASE[n−1], PHASE[n] are expressed as follows.
where k=0, 1, 2, . . . , n−2, n−1, n (k being an integer between 0 and n). The n+1 different phase changing values PHASE[0], PHASE[1] . . . PHASE[i] . . . PHASE[n−1], PHASE[n] are given by Math. 58 (formula 58). PHASE[0] is used once, while PHASE[1] through PHASE[n] are each used twice (i.e., PHASE[1] is used twice, PHASE[2] is used twice, and so on, until PHASE[n−1] is used twice and PHASE[n] is used twice). As such, through this phase changing method in which the phase changing value is regularly switched in a period (cycle) of N=2n+1, a phase changing method is realized in which the phase changing value is regularly switched between fewer phase changing values. Thus, the reception device is able to achieve better data reception quality. As the phase changing values are smaller, the effect thereof on the transmission device and reception device may be reduced. According to the above, the reception device is able to achieve improvements in data reception quality in the LOS environment, and especially in a radio wave propagation environment. In the LOS environment, when the change of phase has not been performed, a regular phase relationship occurs. However, when the change of phase is performed, the phase relationship is modified, in turn avoiding poor conditions in a burst-like propagation environment. As an alternative to Math. 58 (formula 58), PHASE[k] may be calculated as follows.
where k=0, 1, 2, . . . , n−2, n−1, n (k being an integer between 0 and n).
The n+1 different phase changing values PHASE[0], PHASE[1] . . . PHASE[i] . . . PHASE[n−1], PHASE[n] are given by Math. 59 (formula 59). PHASE[0] is used once, while PHASE[1] through PHASE[n] are each used twice (i.e., PHASE[1] is used twice, PHASE[2] is used twice, and so on, until PHASE[n−1] is used twice and PHASE[n] is used twice). As such, through this phase changing method in which the phase changing value is regularly switched in a period (cycle) of N=2n+1, a phase changing method is realized in which the phase changing value is regularly switched between fewer phase changing values. Thus, the reception device is able to achieve better data reception quality. As the phase changing values are smaller, the effect thereof on the transmission device and reception device may be reduced.
As a further alternative, PHASE[k] may be calculated as follows.
where k=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1 (k being an integer between 0 and N−1).
The n+1 different phase changing values PHASE[0], PHASE[1] . . . PHASE[i] . . . PHASE[n−1], PHASE[n] are given by Math. 60 (formula 60). PHASE[0] is used once, while PHASE[1] through PHASE[n] are each used twice (i.e., PHASE[1] is used twice, PHASE[2] is used twice, and so on, until PHASE[n−1] is used twice and PHASE[n] is used twice). As such, through this phase changing method in which the phase changing value is regularly switched in a period (cycle) of N=2n+1, a phase changing method is realized in which the phase changing value is regularly switched between fewer phase changing values. Thus, the reception device is able to achieve better data reception quality. As the phase changing values are smaller, the effect thereof on the transmission device and reception device may be reduced.
As a further alternative, PHASE[k] may be calculated as follows.
where k=0, 1, 2, . . . , n−2, n−1, n (k being an integer between 0 and n).
The n+1 different phase changing values PHASE[0], PHASE[1] . . . PHASE[i] . . . PHASE[n−1], PHASE[n] are given by Math. 61 (formula 61). PHASE[0] is used once, while PHASE[1] through PHASE[n] are each used twice (i.e., PHASE[1] is used twice, PHASE[2] is used twice, and so on, until PHASE[n−1] is used twice and PHASE[n] is used twice). As such, through this phase changing method in which the phase changing value is regularly switched in a period (cycle) of N=2n+1, a phase changing method is realized in which the phase changing value is regularly switched between fewer phase changing values. Thus, the reception device is able to achieve better data reception quality. As the phase changing values are smaller, the effect thereof on the transmission device and reception device may be reduced.
As such, by performing the change of phase according to the present Embodiment, the reception device is made more likely to obtain good reception quality.
The change of phase of the present Embodiment is applicable not only to single-carrier methods but also to transmission using multi-carrier methods. Accordingly, the present Embodiment may also be realized using, for example, spread-spectrum communications, OFDM, SC-FDMA, SC-OFDM, wavelet OFDM as described in Non-Patent Literature 7, and so on. As previously described, while the present Embodiment explains the change of phase as a change of phase with respect to the time domain t, the phase may alternatively be changed with respect to the frequency domain as described in Embodiment 1. That is, considering the change of phase with respect to the time domain t described in the present Embodiment and replacing t with f (f being the ((sub-)carrier) frequency) leads to a change of phase applicable to the frequency domain. Also, as explained above for Embodiment 1, the phase changing method of the present Embodiment is also applicable to a change of phase with respect to both the time domain and the frequency domain.
The present Embodiment describes a method of regularly changing the phase, specifically that of Embodiment C5, when encoding is performed using block codes as described in Non-Patent Literature 12 through 15, such as QC LDPC Codes (not only QC-LDPC but also LDPC codes may be used), concatenated LDPC (blocks) and BCH codes, Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, and so on. The following example considers a case where two streams s1 and s2 are transmitted. When encoding has been performed using block codes and control information and the like is not necessary, the number of bits making up each coded block matches the number of bits making up each block code (control information and so on described below may yet be included). When encoding has been performed using block codes or the like and control information or the like (e.g., CRC transmission parameters) is required, then the number of bits making up each coded block is the sum of the number of bits making up the block codes and the number of bits making up the information.
As shown in
Then, given that the transmission device from
By the same reasoning, when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, 750 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up each coded block, and when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, 500 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up each coded block.
The following describes the relationship between the above-defined slots and the phase, as pertains to methods for a regular change of phase.
Here, five different phase changing values (or phase changing sets) are assumed as having been prepared for use in the method for a regular change of phase, which has a period (cycle) of five. That is, the phase changer of the transmission device from
The following describes the relationship between the above-defined slots and the phase, as pertains to methods for a regular change of phase.
For the above-described 1500 slots needed to transmit the 6000 bits making up a single coded block when the modulation scheme is QPSK, phase changing value P[0] is used on 300 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on 300 slots, phase changing value P[2] is used on 300 slots, phase changing value P[3] is used on 300 slots, and phase changing value P[4] is used on 300 slots. This is due to the fact that any bias in phase changing value usage causes great influence to be exerted by the more frequently used phase changing value, and that the reception device is dependent on such influence for data reception quality.
Similarly, for the above-described 1500 slots needed to transmit the 6000 bits making up the pair of coded blocks when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, phase changing value P[0] is used on 150 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on 150 slots, phase changing value P[2] is used on 150 slots, phase changing value P[3] is used on 150 slots, and phase changing value P[4] is used on 150 slots.
Further, for the above-described 500 slots needed to transmit the 6000 bits making up a single coded block when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, phase changing value P[0] is used on 100 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on 100 slots, phase changing value P[2] is used on 100 slots, phase changing value P[3] is used on 100 slots, and phase changing value P[4] is used on 100 slots.
As described above, a phase changing method for regularly varying the phase changing value as given in Embodiment C5 requires the preparation of N=2n+1 phase changing values P[0], P[1] . . . P[2n−1], P[2n] (where P[0], P[1] . . . P[2n−1], P[2n] are expressed as PHASE[0], PHASE[1], PHASE[2] . . . PHASE[n−1], PHASE[n] (see Embodiment C5)). As such, in order to transmit all of the bits making up the coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used on K0 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on K1 slots, phase changing value P[i] is used on Ki slots (where i=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2n−1, 2n (i being an integer between 0 and 2n)), and phase changing value P[2n] is used on K2 slots, such that Condition #C01 is met.
(Condition #C01)
K0=K1 . . . =Ki= . . . K2n. That is, Ka=Kb (∀a and ∀b where a, b,=0, 1, 2 . . . 2n−1, 2n (a and b being integers between 0 and 2n), a≠b).
A phase changing method for a regular change of phase changing value as given in Embodiment C5 having a period (cycle) of N=2n+1 requires the preparation of phase changing values PHASE[0], PHASE[1], PHASE[2] . . . PHASE[n−1], PHASE[n]. As such, in order to transmit all of the bits making up a single coded block, phase changing value PHASE[0] is used on G0 slots, phase changing value PHASE[1] is used on G1 slots, phase changing value PHASE[i] is used on Gi slots (where i=0, 1, 2, . . . , n−1, n (i being an integer between 0 and n)), and phase changing value PHASE[n] is used on Gn slots, such that Condition #C01 is met. Condition #C01 may be modified as follows.
(Condition #C02)
2×G0=G1 . . . =Gi= . . . Gn. That is, 2×G0=Ga (∀a where a=1, 2 . . . n−1, n (a being an integer between 1 and n).
Then, when a communication system that supports multiple modulation schemes selects one such supported method for use, Condition #C01 (or Condition #C02) is met for the supported modulation scheme.
However, when multiple modulation schemes are supported, each such modulation scheme typically uses symbols transmitting a different number of bits per symbols (though some may happen to use the same number), Condition #C01 (or Condition #C02) may not be satisfied for some modulation schemes. In such a case, the following condition applies instead of Condition #C01.
(Condition #C03)
The difference between Ka and Kb satisfies 0 or 1. That is, |Ka−Kb| satisfies 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . 2n−1, 2n (a and b being integers between 0 and 2n), a≠b).
Alternatively, Condition #C03 may be expressed as follows.
(Condition #C04)
The difference between Ga and Gb satisfies 0, 1, or 2. That is, |Ga−Gb| satisfies 0, 1, or 2 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=1, 2 . . . n−1, n (a and b being integers between 1 and n), a≠b)
and
The difference between 2×G0 and Ga satisfies 0, 1, or 2. That is, |2×G0−Ga| satisfies 0, 1, or 2 (∀a, where a=1, 2 . . . n−1, n (a being an integer between 1 and n)).
As shown in
The transmission device from
By the same reasoning, when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, 1500 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up two coded blocks, and when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, 1000 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up the two coded blocks.
The following describes the relationship between the above-defined slots and the phase, as pertains to methods for a regular change of phase.
Here, five different phase changing values (or phase changing sets) are assumed as having been prepared for use in the method for a regular change of phase, which has a period (cycle) of five. That is, the phase changer of the transmission device from
For the above-described 3000 slots needed to transmit the 6000×2 bits making up the pair of coded blocks when the modulation scheme is QPSK, phase changing value P[0] is used on 600 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on 600 slots, phase changing value P[2] is used on 600 slots, phase changing value P[3] is used on 600 slots, and phase changing value P[4] is used on 600 slots. This is due to the fact that any bias in phase changing value usage causes great influence to be exerted by the more frequently used phase changing value, and that the reception device is dependent on such influence for data reception quality.
Further, in order to transmit the first coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used on slots 600 times, phase changing value P[1] is used on slots 600 times, phase changing value P[2] is used on slots 600 times, phase changing value P[3] is used on slots 600 times, and phase changing value PHASE[4] is used on slots 600 times. Furthermore, in order to transmit the second coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used on slots 600 times, phase changing value P[1] is used on slots 600 times, phase changing value P[2] is used on slots 600 times, phase changing value P[3] is used on slots 600 times, and phase changing value P[4] is used on slots 600 times.
Similarly, for the above-described 1500 slots needed to transmit the 6000×2 bits making up the pair of coded blocks when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, phase changing value P[0] is used on 300 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on 300 slots, phase changing value P[2] is used on 300 slots, phase changing value P[3] is used on 300 slots, and phase changing value P[4] is used on 300 slots.
Furthermore, in order to transmit the first coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used on slots 300 times, phase changing value P[1] is used on slots 300 times, phase changing value P[2] is used on slots 300 times, phase changing value P[3] is used on slots 300 times, and phase changing value P[4] is used on slots 300 times. Furthermore, in order to transmit the second coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used on slots 300 times, phase changing value P[1] is used on slots 300 times, phase changing value P[2] is used on slots 300 times, phase changing value P[3] is used on slots 300 times, and phase changing value P[4] is used on slots 300 times.
Similarly, for the above-described 1000 slots needed to transmit the 6000×2 bits making up the pair of coded blocks when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, phase changing value P[0] is used on 200 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on 200 slots, phase changing value P[2] is used on 200 slots, phase changing value P[3] is used on 200 slots, and phase changing value P[4] is used on 200 slots.
Furthermore, in order to transmit the first coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used on slots 200 times, phase changing value P[1] is used on slots 200 times, phase changing value P[2] is used on slots 200 times, phase changing value P[3] is used on slots 200 times, and phase changing value P[4] is used on slots 200 times. Furthermore, in order to transmit the second coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used on slots 200 times, phase changing value P[1] is used on slots 200 times, phase changing value P[2] is used on slots 200 times, phase changing value P[3] is used on slots 200 times, and phase changing value P[4] is used on slots 200 times.
As described above, a phase changing method for regularly varying the phase changing value as given in Embodiment C5 requires the preparation of N=2n+1 phase changing values P[0], P[1] . . . P[2n−1], P[2n] (where P[0], P[1] . . . P[2n−1], P[2n] are expressed as PHASE[0], PHASE[1], PHASE[2] PHASE[n−1], PHASE[n] (see Embodiment C5)). As such, in order to transmit all of the bits making up the two coded blocks, phase changing value P[0] is used on K0 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on K1 slots, phase changing value P[i] is used on Ki slots (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . 2n−1, 2n (i being an integer between 0 and 2n)), and phase changing value P[2n] is used on K2n slots.
(Condition #C05)
K0=K1 . . . =Ki= . . . K2n. That is, Ka=Kb (∀a and ∀b where a, b, =0, 1, 2 . . . 2n−1, 2n (a and b being integers between 0 and 2n, a≠b).
In order to transmit all of the bits making up the first coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used K0,1 times, phase changing value P[1] is used K1,1 times, phase changing value P[i] is used Ki,1 (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . 2n−1, 2n (i being an integer between 0 and 2n)), and phase changing value P[2n] is used K2n,1 times.
(Condition #C06)
K0,1=K1,1 . . . =Ki,1= . . . K2n,1. That is, Ka,1=Kb,1 (∀a and ∀b where a, b, =0, 1, 2 . . . 2n−1, 2n (a and b being integers between 0 and 2n), a≠b).
In order to transmit all of the bits making up the second coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used K0,2 times, phase changing value P[1] is used K1,2 times, phase changing value P[i] is used Ki,2 (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . 2n−1, 2n (i being an integer between 0 and 2n)), and phase changing value P[2n] is used K2n,2 times.
(Condition #C07)
K0,2=K1,2 . . . =Ki,2= . . . K2n,2. That is, Ka,2=Kb,2 (∀a and ∀b where a, b, =0, 1, 2 . . . 2n−1, 2n (a and b being integers between 0 and 2n), a≠b).
A phase changing method for regularly varying the phase changing value as given in Embodiment C5 having a period (cycle) of N=2n+1 requires the preparation of phase changing values PHASE[0], PHASE[1], PHASE[2] PHASE[n−1], PHASE[n]. As such, in order to transmit all of the bits making up the two coded blocks, phase changing value PHASE[0] is used on G0 slots, phase changing value PHASE[1] is used on G1 slots, phase changing value PHASE[i] is used on Gi slots (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . n−1, n (i being an integer between 0 and n)), and phase changing value PHASE[n] is used on Gn slots, such that Condition #C05 is met.
(Condition #C08)
2×G0=G1 . . . =Gi= . . . Gn. That is, 2×G0=Ga (∀a where a=1, 2 . . . n−1, n (a being an integer between 1 and n)).
In order to transmit all of the bits making up the first coded block, phase changing value PHASE[0] is used G0,1 times, phase changing value PHASE[1] is used G1,1 times, phase changing value PHASE[i] is used G0 (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . n−1, n being an integer between 0 and n)), and phase changing value PHASE[n] is used Gn,1 times.
(Condition #C09)
2×G0,1=G1,1 . . . =Gi,1= . . . Gn,1. That is, 2×G01=Ga,1 (∀a where a=1, 2 . . . n−1, n (a being an integer between 1 and n)).
In order to transmit all of the bits making up the second coded block, phase changing value PHASE[0] is used G0,2 times, phase changing value PHASE[1] is used G1,2 times, phase changing value PHASE[i] is used G1,2 (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . n−1, n being an integer between 0 and n)), and phase changing value PHASE[n] is used Gn,1 times.
(Condition #C10)
2×G0,2=G1,2 . . . =Gi,2= . . . Gn,2. That is, 2×G0,2=Ga,2 (∀a where a=1, 2 . . . n−1, n (a being an integer between 1 and n)).
Then, when a communication system that supports multiple modulation schemes selects one such supported method for use, Condition #C05, Condition #C06, and Condition #C07 (or Condition #C08, Condition #C09, and Condition #C10) is met for the supported modulation scheme.
However, when multiple modulation schemes are supported, each such modulation scheme typically uses symbols transmitting a different number of bits per symbols (though some may happen to use the same number), Condition #C05, Condition #C06, and Condition #C07 (or Condition #C08, Condition #C09, and Condition #C10) may not be satisfied for some modulation schemes. In such a case, the following conditions apply instead of Condition #C05, Condition #C06, and Condition #C07.
(Condition #C11)
The difference between Ka and Kb satisfies 0 or 1. That is, |Ka−Kb| satisfies 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . 2n−1, 2n (a and b being integers between 0 and 2n), a≠b).
(Condition #C12)
The difference between Ka,1 and Kb,1 satisfies 0 or 1. That is, |Ka,1−Kb,1 satisfies 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . 2n−1, 2n (a and b being integers between 0 and 2n), a≠b).
(Condition #C13)
The difference between Ka,2 and Kb,2 satisfies 0 or 1. That is, |Ka,2−Kb,2 satisfies 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . 2n−1, 2n (a and b being integers between 0 and 2n), a≠b).
Alternatively, Condition #C11, Condition #C12, and Condition #C13 may be expressed as follows.
(Condition #C14)
The difference between Ga and Gb satisfies 0, 1, or 2. That is, |Ga−Gb| satisfies 0, 1, or 2 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=1, 2 . . . n−1, n (a and b being integers between 1 and n), a≠b)
and
The difference between 2×G0 and Ga satisfies 0, 1, or 2. That is, |2×G0−Ga| satisfies 0, 1, or 2 (∀a, where a=1, 2 . . . n−1, n (a being an integer between 1 and n)).
(Condition #C15)
The difference between Ga,1 and Gb,1 satisfies 0, 1, or 2. That is, |Ga,1−Gb,1| satisfies 0, 1, or 2 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=1, 2 . . . n−1, n (a and b being integers between 1 and n), a≠b)
and
The difference between 2×G0,1 and Ga,1 satisfies 0, 1, or 2. That is, |2×G0,1−Ga,1| satisfies 0, 1, or 2 (∀a, where a=1, 2 . . . n−1, n (a being an integer between 1 and n))
(Condition #C16)
The difference between Ga,2 and Gb,2 satisfies 0, 1, or 2. That is, |Ga,2−Gb,2| satisfies 0, 1, or 2 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=1, 2 . . . n−1, n (a and b being integers between 1 and n), a≠b)
and
The difference between 2×G0,2 and Ga,2 satisfies 0, 1, or 2. That is, |2×G0,2−Ga,2 satisfies 0, 1, or 2 (∀a, where a=1, 2 . . . n−1, n (a being an integer between 1 and n))
As described above, bias among the phase changing values being used to transmit the coded blocks is removed by creating a relationship between the coded block and the phase changing values. As such, data reception quality can be improved for the reception device.
In the present Embodiment, N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) are needed in order to perform a change of phase having a period (cycle) of N with the method for a regular change of phase. As such, N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) P[0], P[1], P[2] . . . P[N−2], and P[N−1] are prepared. However, schemes exist for ordering the phases in the stated order with respect to the frequency domain. No limitation is intended in this regard. The N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) P[0], P[1], P[2] . . . P[N−2], and P[N−1] may also change the phases of blocks in the time domain or in the time-frequency domain to obtain a symbol arrangement as described in Embodiment 1. Although the above examples discuss a phase changing scheme with a period (cycle) of N, the same effects are obtainable using N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) at random. That is, the N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) need not always have regular periodicity. As long as the above-described conditions are satisfied, quality data reception improvements are realizable for the reception device.
Furthermore, given the existence of modes for spatial multiplexing MIMO methods, MIMO methods using a fixed precoding matrix, space-time block coding methods, single-stream transmission, and methods using a regular change of phase, the transmission device (broadcaster, base station) may select any one of these transmission methods.
As described in Non-Patent Literature 3, spatial multiplexing MIMO methods involve transmitting signals s1 and s2, which are mapped using a selected modulation scheme, on each of two different antennas. MIMO methods using a fixed precoding matrix involve performing precoding only (with no change in phase). Further, space-time block coding methods are described in Non-Patent Literature 9, 16, and 17. Single-stream transmission methods involve transmitting signal s1, mapped with a selected modulation scheme, from an antenna after performing predetermined processing.
Schemes using multi-carrier transmission such as OFDM involve a first carrier group made up of a plurality of carriers and a second carrier group made up of a plurality of carriers different from the first carrier group, and so on, such that multi-carrier transmission is realized with a plurality of carrier groups. For each carrier group, any of spatial multiplexing MIMO schemes, MIMO schemes using a fixed precoding matrix, space-time block coding schemes, single-stream transmission, and schemes using a regular change of phase may be used. In particular, schemes using a regular change of phase on a selected (sub-)carrier group are preferably used to realize the present Embodiment.
When a change of phase by, for example, a phase changing value for P[i] of X radians is performed on only one precoded baseband signal, the phase changers of
The present Embodiment describes a method of regularly changing the phase, specifically as done in Embodiment A1 and Embodiment C6, when encoding is performed using block codes as described in Non-Patent Literature 12 through 15, such as QC LDPC Codes (not only QC-LDPC but also LDPC (block) codes may be used), concatenated LDPC and BCH codes, Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes, and so on. The following example considers a case where two streams s1 and s2 are transmitted. When encoding has been performed using block codes and control information and the like is not necessary, the number of bits making up each coded block matches the number of bits making up each block code (control information and so on described below may yet be included). When encoding has been performed using block codes or the like and control information or the like (e.g., CRC transmission parameters) is required, then the number of bits making up each coded block is the sum of the number of bits making up the block codes and the number of bits making up the information.
As shown in
Then, given that the transmission device from
By the same reasoning, when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, 750 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up two coded blocks, and when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, 500 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up the two coded blocks.
The following describes the relationship between the above-defined slots and the phase, as pertains to methods for a regular change of phase.
Here, five different phase changing values (or phase changing sets) are assumed as having been prepared for use in the method for a regular change of phase, which has a period (cycle) of five. The phase changing values (or phase changing sets) prepared in order to regularly change the phase with a period (cycle) of five are P[0], P[1], P[2], P[3], and P[4]. However, P[0], P[1], P[2], P[3], and P[4] should include at least two different phase changing values (i.e., P[0], P[1], P[2], P[3], and P[4] may include identical phase changing values). (As in
For the above-described 1500 slots needed to transmit the 6000 bits making up a single coded block when the modulation scheme is QPSK, phase changing value P[0] is used on 300 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on 300 slots, phase changing value P[2] is used on 300 slots, phase changing value P[3] is used on 300 slots, and phase changing value P[4] is used on 300 slots. This is due to the fact that any bias in phase changing value usage causes great influence to be exerted by the more frequently used phase changing value, and that the reception device is dependent on such influence for data reception quality.
Further, for the above-described 750 slots needed to transmit the 6000 bits making up a single coded block when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, phase changing value P[0] is used on 150 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on 150 slots, phase changing value P[2] is used on 150 slots, phase changing value P[3] is used on 150 slots, and phase changing value P[4] is used on 150 slots.
Further, for the above-described 500 slots needed to transmit the 6000 bits making up a single coded block when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, phase changing value P[0] is used on 100 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on 100 slots, phase changing value P[2] is used on 100 slots, phase changing value P[3] is used on 100 slots, and phase changing value P[4] is used on 100 slots.
As described above, the phase changing values used in the phase changing method regularly switching between phase changing values with a period (cycle) of N are expressed as P[0], P[1] . . . P[N−2], P[N−1]. However, P[0], P[1] . . . P[N−2], P[N−1] should include at least two different phase changing values (i.e., P[0], P[1] . . . P[N−2], P[N−1] may include identical phase changing values). In order to transmit all of the bits making up a single coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used on K0 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on K1 slots, phase changing value P[i] is used on Ki slots (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (i being an integer between 0 and N−1)), and phase changing value P[N−1] is used on KN-1 slots, such that Condition #C17 is met.
(Condition #C17)
K0=K1 . . . =Ki= . . . KN-1. That is, Ka=Kb (∀a and ∀b where a, b, =0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b).
Then, when a communication system that supports multiple modulation schemes selects one such supported method for use, Condition #C17 is met for the supported modulation scheme.
However, when multiple modulation schemes are supported, each such modulation scheme typically uses symbols transmitting a different number of bits per symbols (though some may happen to use the same number), Condition #C17 may not be satisfied for some modulation schemes. In such a case, the following condition applies instead of Condition #C17.
(Condition #C18)
The difference between Ka and Kb satisfies 0 or 1. That is, |Ka−Kb| satisfies 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b).
As shown in
The transmission device from
By the same reasoning, when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, 1500 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up two coded blocks, and when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, 1000 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up the two coded blocks.
The following describes the relationship between the above-defined slots and the phase, as pertains to methods for a regular change of phase.
Here, five different phase changing values (or phase changing sets) are assumed as having been prepared for use in the method for a regular change of phase, which has a period (cycle) of five. That is, the phase changer of the transmission device from
For the above-described 3000 slots needed to transmit the 6000×2 bits making up the pair of coded blocks when the modulation scheme is QPSK, phase changing value P[0] is used on 600 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on 600 slots, phase changing value P[2] is used on 600 slots, phase changing value P[3] is used on 600 slots, and phase changing value P[4] is used on 600 slots. This is due to the fact that any bias in phase changing value usage causes great influence to be exerted by the more frequently used phase changing value, and that the reception device is dependent on such influence for data reception quality.
Further, in order to transmit the first coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used on slots 600 times, phase changing value P[1] is used on slots 600 times, phase changing value P[2] is used on slots 600 times, phase changing value P[3] is used on slots 600 times, and phase changing value PHASE[4] is used on slots 600 times. Furthermore, in order to transmit the second coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used on slots 600 times, phase changing value P[1] is used on slots 600 times, phase changing value P[2] is used on slots 600 times, phase changing value P[3] is used on slots 600 times, and phase changing value P[4] is used on slots 600 times.
Similarly, for the above-described 1500 slots needed to transmit the 6000×2 bits making up the pair of coded blocks when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, phase changing value P[0] is used on 300 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on 300 slots, phase changing value P[2] is used on 300 slots, phase changing value P[3] is used on 300 slots, and phase changing value P[4] is used on 300 slots.
Furthermore, in order to transmit the first coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used on slots 300 times, phase changing value P[1] is used on slots 300 times, phase changing value P[2] is used on slots 300 times, phase changing value P[3] is used on slots 300 times, and phase changing value P[4] is used on slots 300 times. Furthermore, in order to transmit the second coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used on slots 300 times, phase changing value P[1] is used on slots 300 times, phase changing value P[2] is used on slots 300 times, phase changing value P[3] is used on slots 300 times, and phase changing value P[4] is used on slots 300 times.
Furthermore, for the above-described 1000 slots needed to transmit the 6000×2 bits making up the two coded blocks when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, phase changing value P[0] is used on 200 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on 200 slots, phase changing value P[2] is used on 200 slots, phase changing value P[3] is used on 200 slots, and phase changing value P[4] is used on 200 slots.
Furthermore, in order to transmit the first coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used on slots 200 times, phase changing value P[1] is used on slots 200 times, phase changing value P[2] is used on slots 200 times, phase changing value P[3] is used on slots 200 times, and phase changing value P[4] is used on slots 200 times. Furthermore, in order to transmit the second coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used on slots 200 times, phase changing value P[1] is used on slots 200 times, phase changing value P[2] is used on slots 200 times, phase changing value P[3] is used on slots 200 times, and phase changing value P[4] is used on slots 200 times.
As described above, the phase changing values used in the phase changing method regularly switching between phase changing values with a period (cycle) of N are expressed as P[0], P[1] . . . P[N−2], P[N−1]. However, P[0], P[1] . . . P[N−2], P[N−1] should include at least two different phase changing values (i.e., P[0], P[1] . . . P[N−2], P[N−1] may include identical phase changing values). In order to transmit all of the bits making up a single coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used on K0 slots, phase changing value P[1] is used on K1 slots, phase changing value P[i] is used on Ki slots (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (i being an integer between 0 and N−1)), and phase changing value P[N−1] is used on KN-1 slots, such that Condition #C19 is met.
(Condition #C19)
K0=K1 . . . =Ki= . . . KN-1. That is, Ka=Kb (∀a and ∀b where a, b, =0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b).
In order to transmit all of the bits making up the first coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used K0,1 times, phase changing value P[1] is used K1,1 times, phase changing value P[i] is used Ki,1 (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (i being an integer between 0 and N−1)), and phase changing value P[N−1] is used KN-1,1 times.
(Condition #C20)
K0,1=K1,1= . . . Ki,1= . . . KN-1,1. That is, Ka,1=Kb,1 (∀a and ∀b where a, b, =0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b).
In order to transmit all of the bits making up the second coded block, phase changing value P[0] is used K0,2 times, phase changing value P[1] is used K1,2 times, phase changing value P[i] is used Ki,2 (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (i being an integer between 0 and N−1)), and phase changing value P[N−1] is used KN-1,2 times.
(Condition #C21)
K0,2=K1,2= . . . Ki,2= . . . KN-1,2. That is, Ka,2=Kb,2 (∀a and ∀b where a, b, =0, 1, 2 . . . N−1, a≠b).
Then, when a communication system that supports multiple modulation schemes selects one such supported method for use, Condition #C19, Condition #C20, and Condition #C21 are preferably met for the supported modulation scheme.
However, when multiple modulation schemes are supported, each such modulation scheme typically uses symbols transmitting a different number of bits per symbols (though some may happen to use the same number), Condition #C19, Condition #C20, and Condition #C21 may not be satisfied for some modulation schemes. In such a case, the following conditions apply instead of Condition #C19, Condition #C20, and Condition #C21.
(Condition #C22)
The difference between Ka and Kb satisfies 0 or 1. That is, |Ka−Kb| satisfies 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b).
(Condition #C23)
The difference between Ka,1 and Kb,1 satisfies 0 or 1. That is, |Ka,1−Kb,1| satisfies 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b).
(Condition #C24)
The difference between Ka,2 and Kb,2 satisfies 0 or 1. That is, |Ka,2−Kb,2| satisfies 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b).
As described above, bias among the phase changing values being used to transmit the coded blocks is removed by creating a relationship between the coded block and the phase changing values. As such, data reception quality can be improved for the reception device.
In the present Embodiment, N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) are needed in order to perform a change of phase having a period (cycle) of N with the method for a regular change of phase. As such, N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) P[0], P[1], P[2] . . . P[N−2], and P[N−1] are prepared. However, methods exist for ordering the phases in the stated order with respect to the frequency domain. No limitation is intended in this regard. The N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) P[0], P[1], P[2] . . . P[N−2], and P[N−1] may also change the phases of blocks in the time domain or in the time-frequency domain to obtain a symbol arrangement as described in Embodiment 1. Although the above examples discuss a phase changing method with a period (cycle) of N, the same effects are obtainable using N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) at random. That is, the N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) need not always have regular periodicity. As long as the above-described conditions are satisfied, great quality data reception improvements are realizable for the reception device.
Furthermore, given the existence of modes for spatial multiplexing MIMO methods, MIMO methods using a fixed precoding matrix, space-time block coding methods, single-stream transmission, and methods using a regular change of phase, the transmission device (broadcaster, base station) may select any one of these transmission methods.
As described in Non-Patent Literature 3, spatial multiplexing MIMO methods involve transmitting signals s1 and s2, which are mapped using a selected modulation scheme, on each of two different antennas. MIMO methods using a fixed precoding matrix involve performing precoding only (with no change in phase). Further, space-time block coding methods are described in Non-Patent Literature 9, 16, and 17. Single-stream transmission methods involve transmitting signal s1, mapped with a selected modulation scheme, from an antenna after performing predetermined processing.
Schemes using multi-carrier transmission such as OFDM involve a first carrier group made up of a plurality of carriers and a second carrier group made up of a plurality of carriers different from the first carrier group, and so on, such that multi-carrier transmission is realized with a plurality of carrier groups. For each carrier group, any of spatial multiplexing MIMO schemes, MIMO schemes using a fixed precoding matrix, space-time block coding schemes, single-stream transmission, and schemes using a regular change of phase may be used. In particular, schemes using a regular change of phase on a selected (sub-)carrier group are preferably used to realize the present Embodiment.
When a change of phase by, for example, a phase changing value for P[i] of X radians is performed on only one precoded baseband signal, the phase changers of
The present Embodiment is first described as a variation of Embodiment 1.
Here, the precoding matrix is
In Math. 62 (formula 62), above, α is given by:
Alternatively, in Math. 62 (formula 62), above, α may be given by:
Alternatively, the precoding matrix is not restricted to that of Math. 62 (formula 62), but may also be:
where a=Aejδ11, b=Bejδ12, c=Cejδ21, and d=Dejδ22. Further, one of a, b, c, and d may be equal to zero. For example: (1) a may be zero while b, c, and d are non-zero, (2) b may be zero while a, c, and d are non-zero, (3) c may be zero while a, b, and d are non-zero, or (4) d may be zero while a, b, and c are non-zero.
Alternatively, any two of a, b, c, and d may be equal to zero. For example, (1) a and d may be zero while b and c are non-zero, or (2) b and c may be zero while a and d are non-zero.
When any of the modulation scheme, error-correcting codes, and the coding rate thereof are changed, the precoding matrix in use may also be set and changed, or the same precoding matrix may be used as-is.
Next, the baseband signal switcher 6702 from
In
Here, the baseband components are switched by the baseband signal switcher 6702, such that:
Also, while the above examples describe switching performed on baseband signals having a common timestamp (common (sub-)carrier) frequency), the baseband signals being switched need not necessarily have a common timestamp (common (sub-)carrier) frequency). For example, any of the following are possible.
Here, weighted signal 309A(p1(i)) has an in-phase component I of Ip1(i) and a quadrature component Q of Qp1(i), while weighted signal 316B(p2(i)) has an in-phase component I of Ip2(i) and a quadrature component Q of Qp2(i). In contrast, switched baseband signal 6701A(q1(i)) has an in-phase component I of Iq1(i) and a quadrature component Q of Qq1(i), while switched baseband signal 6701B(q2(i)) has an in-phase component Iq2(i) and a quadrature component Q of Qq2(i).
In
As such, in-phase component I of Iq1(i) and quadrature component Q of Qq1(i) of switched baseband signal 6701A(q1(i)) and in-phase component Iq2(i) and quadrature component Q of Qq2(i) of baseband signal 6701B(q2(i)) are expressible as any of the above.
As such, the modulated signal corresponding to switched baseband signal 6701A(q1(i)) is transmitted from transmit antenna 312A, while the modulated signal corresponding to switched baseband signal 6701B(q2(i)) is transmitted from transmit antenna 312B, both being transmitted simultaneously on a common frequency. Thus, the modulated signals corresponding to switched baseband signal 6701A(q1(i)) and switched baseband signal 6701B(q2(i)) are transmitted from different antennas, simultaneously on a common frequency.
Phase changer 317B takes switched baseband signal 6701B and signal processing method information 315 as input and regularly changes the phase of switched baseband signal 6701B for output. This regular change is a change of phase performed according to a predetermined phase changing pattern having a predetermined period (cycle) (e.g., every n symbols (n being an integer, n≧1) or at a predetermined interval). The phase changing pattern is described in detail in Embodiment 4.
Wireless unit 310B takes post-phase change signal 309B as input and performs processing such as quadrature modulation, band limitation, frequency conversion, amplification, and so on, then outputs transmit signal 311B. Transmit signal 311B is then output as radio waves by an antenna 312B.
Symbol 501_1 is for estimating channel fluctuations for modulated signal z1(t) (where t is time) transmitted by the transmission device. Symbol 502_1 is a data symbol transmitted by modulated signal z1(t) as symbol number u (in the time domain). Symbol 503_1 is a data symbol transmitted by modulated signal z1(t) as symbol number u+1.
Symbol 501_2 is for estimating channel fluctuations for modulated signal z2(t) (where t is time) transmitted by the transmission device. Symbol 502_2 is a data symbol transmitted by modulated signal z2(t) as symbol number u. Symbol 503_2 is a data symbol transmitted by modulated signal z1(t) as symbol number u+1.
Here, the symbols of z1(t) and of z2(t) having the same timestamp (identical timing) are transmitted from the transmit antenna using the same (shared/common) frequency.
The following describes the relationships between the modulated signals z1(t) and z2(t) transmitted by the transmission device and the received signals r1(t) and r2(t) received by the reception device.
In
Here, given vector W1=(w11,w12) from the first row of the fixed precoding matrix F, p1(t) can be expressed as Math. 67 (formula 67), below.
[Math. 67]
p1(t)=W1s1(t) (formula 67)
Here, given vector W2=(w21,w22) from the first row of the fixed precoding matrix F, p2(t) can be expressed as Math. 68 (formula 68), below.
[Math. 68]
p2(t)=W2s2(t) (formula 68)
Accordingly, precoding matrix F may be expressed as follows.
After the baseband signals have been switched, switched baseband signal 6701A(q1(i)) has an in-phase component I of Iq1(i) and a quadrature component Q of Qp1(i), and switched baseband signal 6701B(q2(i)) has an in-phase component I of Iq2(i) and a quadrature component Q of Qq2(i). The relationships between all of these are as stated above. When the phase changer uses phase changing formula y(t), the post-phase change baseband signal 309B(q′2(i)) is given by Math. 70 (formula 70), below.
[Math. 70]
q2′(t)=y(t)q2(t) (formula 70)
Here, y(t) is a phase changing formula obeying a predetermined method. For example, given a period (cycle) of four and timestamp u, the phase changing formula may be expressed as Math. 71 (formula 71), below.
[Math. 71]
y(u)=ej0 (formula 71)
Similarly, the phase changing formula for timestamp u+1 may be, for example, as given by Math. 72 (formula 72).
That is, the phase changing formula for timestamp u+k generalizes to Math. 73 (formula 73).
Note that Math. 71 (formula 71) through Math. 73 (formula 73) are given only as an example of a regular change of phase.
The regular change of phase is not restricted to a period (cycle) of four. Improved reception capabilities (the error-correction capabilities, to be exact) may potentially be promoted in the reception device by increasing the period (cycle) number (this does not mean that a greater period (cycle) is better, though avoiding small numbers such as two is likely ideal).
Furthermore, although Math. 71 (formula 71) through Math. 73 (formula 73), above, represent a configuration in which a change of phase is carried out through rotation by consecutive predetermined phases (in the above formula, every π/2), the change of phase need not be rotation by a constant amount but may also be random. For example, in accordance with the predetermined period (cycle) of y(t), the phase may be changed through sequential multiplication as shown in Math. 74 (formula 74) and Math. 75 (formula 75). The key point of the regular change of phase is that the phase of the modulated signal is regularly changed. The phase changing degree variance rate is preferably as even as possible, such as from −π radians to π radians. However, given that this concerns a distribution, random variance is also possible.
As such, the weighting unit 600 of
When a specialized precoding matrix is used in the LOS environment, the reception quality is likely to improve tremendously. However, depending on the direct wave conditions, the phase and amplitude components of the direct wave may greatly differ from the specialized precoding matrix, upon reception. The LOS environment has certain rules. Thus, data reception quality is tremendously improved through a regular change of transmit signal phase that obeys those rules. The present invention offers a signal processing method for improving the LOS environment.
Channel fluctuation estimator 705_1 for modulated signal z1 transmitted by the transmission device takes baseband signal 704_X as input, extracts reference symbol 501_1 for channel estimation from
Channel fluctuation estimator 705_2 for modulated signal z2 transmitted by the transmission device takes baseband signal 704_X as input, extracts reference symbol 501_2 for channel estimation from
Wireless unit 703_Y receives, as input, received signal 702_Y received by antenna 701_X, performs processing such as frequency conversion, quadrature demodulation, and the like, and outputs baseband signal 704_Y.
Channel fluctuation estimator 707_1 for modulated signal z1 transmitted by the transmission device takes baseband signal 704_Y as input, extracts reference symbol 501_1 for channel estimation from
Channel fluctuation estimator 707_2 for modulated signal z2 transmitted by the transmission device takes baseband signal 704_Y as input, extracts reference symbol 501_2 for channel estimation from
A control information decoder 709 receives baseband signal 704_X and baseband signal 704_Y as input, detects symbol 500_1 that indicates the transmission method from
A signal processor 711 takes the baseband signals 704_X and 704_Y, the channel estimation signals 706_1, 706_2, 708_1, and 708_2, and the transmission method information signal 710 as input, performs detection and decoding, and then outputs received data 712_1 and 712_2.
Next, the operations of the signal processor 711 from
Accordingly, the coefficient generator 819 from
The inner MIMO detector 803 takes the signal processing method information signal 820 as input and performs iterative detection and decoding using the signal. The operations are described below.
The processing unit illustrated in
In
Subsequent operations are described separately for initial detection and for iterative decoding (iterative detection).
(Initial Detection)
The inner MIMO detector 803 takes baseband signal 801X, channel estimation signal group 802X, baseband signal 801Y, and channel estimation signal group 802Y as input. Here, the modulation scheme for modulated signal (stream) s1 and modulated signal (stream) s2 is described as 16-QAM.
The inner MIMO detector 803 first computes a candidate signal point corresponding to baseband signal 801X from the channel estimation signal groups 802X and 802Y.
Similarly, the inner MIMO detector 803 calculates candidate signal points corresponding to baseband signal 801Y from channel estimation signal group 802X and channel estimation signal group 802Y, computes the Euclidean squared distance between each of the candidate signal points and the received signal points (corresponding to baseband signal 801Y), and divides the Euclidean squared distance by the noise variance σ2. Accordingly, EY(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) is calculated. That is, EY is the Euclidian squared distance between a candidate signal point corresponding to (b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) and a received signal point, divided by the noise variance.
Next, EX(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7)+EY(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7)=E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) is computed.
The inner MIMO detector 803 outputs E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) as the signal 804.
Log-likelihood calculator 805A takes the signal 804 as input, calculates the log-likelihood of bits b0, b1, b2, and b3, and outputs a log-likelihood signal 806A. Note that this log-likelihood calculation produces the log-likelihood of a bit being 1 and the log-likelihood of a bit being 0. The calculation method is as shown in Math. 28 (formula 28), Math. 29 (formula 29), and Math. 30 (formula 30), and the details are given by Non-Patent Literature 2 and 3.
Similarly, log-likelihood calculator 805B takes the signal 804 as input, calculates the log-likelihood of bits b4, b5, b6, and b7, and outputs log-likelihood signal 806B.
A deinterleaver (807A) takes log-likelihood signal 806A as input, performs deinterleaving corresponding to that of the interleaver (the interleaver (304A) from
Similarly, a deinterleaver (807B) takes log-likelihood signal 806B as input, performs deinterleaving corresponding to that of the interleaver (the interleaver (6704B) from
Log-likelihood ratio calculator 809A takes deinterleaved log-likelihood signal 808A as input, calculates the log-likelihood ratio of the bits encoded by encoder 6702A from
Similarly, log-likelihood ratio calculator 809B takes deinterleaved log-likelihood signal 808B as input, calculates the log-likelihood ratio of the bits encoded by encoder 302B from
Soft-in/soft-out decoder 811A takes log-likelihood ratio signal 810A as input, performs decoding, and outputs a decoded log-likelihood ratio 812A.
Similarly, soft-in/soft-out decoder 811B takes log-likelihood ratio signal 810B as input, performs decoding, and outputs decoded log-likelihood ratio 812B.
(Iterative Decoding (Iterative Detection), k Iterations)
The interleaver (813A) takes the k−1th decoded log-likelihood ratio 812A decoded by the soft-in/soft-out decoder as input, performs interleaving, and outputs interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814A. Here, the interleaving pattern used by the interleaver (813A) is identical to that of the interleaver (304A) from
Another interleaver (813B) takes the k−1th decoded log-likelihood ratio 812B decoded by the soft-in/soft-out decoder as input, performs interleaving, and outputs interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814B. Here, the interleaving pattern used by the interleaver (813B) is identical to that of the other interleaver (304B) from
The inner MIMO detector 803 takes baseband signal 816X, transformed channel estimation signal group 817X, baseband signal 816Y, transformed channel estimation signal group 817Y, interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814A, and interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814B as input. Here, baseband signal 816X, transformed channel estimation signal group 817X, baseband signal 816Y, and transformed channel estimation signal group 817Y are used instead of baseband signal 801X, channel estimation signal group 802X, baseband signal 801Y, and channel estimation signal group 802Y because the latter cause delays due to the iterative decoding.
The iterative decoding operations of the inner MIMO detector 803 differ from the initial detection operations thereof in that the interleaved log-likelihood ratios 814A and 814B are used in signal processing for the former. The inner MIMO detector 803 first calculates E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) in the same manner as for initial detection. In addition, the coefficients corresponding to Math. 11 (formula 11) and Math. 32 (formula 32) are computed from the interleaved log-likelihood ratios 814A and 914B. The value of E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) is corrected using the coefficients so calculated to obtain E′(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7), which is output as the signal 804.
The log-likelihood calculator 805A takes the signal 804 as input, calculates the log-likelihood of bits b0, b1, b2, and b3, and outputs the log-likelihood signal 806A. Note that this log-likelihood calculation produces the log-likelihood of a bit being 1 and the log-likelihood of a bit being 0. The calculation method is as shown in Math. 31 (formula 31) through Math. 35 (formula 35), and the details are given by Non-Patent Literature 2 and 3.
Similarly, log-likelihood calculator 805B takes the signal 804 as input, calculates the log-likelihood of bits b4, b5, b6, and b7, and outputs log-likelihood signal 806B. Operations performed by the deinterleaver onwards are similar to those performed for initial detection.
While
As shown in Non-Patent Literature 5 and the like, QR decomposition may also be used to perform initial detection and iterative detection. Also, as indicated by Non-Patent Literature 11, MMSE and ZF linear operations may be performed when performing initial detection.
As described above, when a transmission device according to the present Embodiment using a MIMO system transmits a plurality of modulated signals from a plurality of antennas, changing the phase over time while multiplying by the precoding matrix so as to regularly change the phase results in improvements to data reception quality for a reception device in a LOS environment, where direct waves are dominant, compared to a conventional spatial multiplexing MIMO system.
In the present Embodiment, and particularly in the configuration of the reception device, the number of antennas is limited and explanations are given accordingly. However, the Embodiment may also be applied to a greater number of antennas. In other words, the number of antennas in the reception device does not affect the operations or advantageous effects of the present Embodiment.
Further, in the present Embodiments, the encoding is not particularly limited to LDPC codes. Similarly, the decoding method is not limited to implementation by a soft-in/soft-out decoder using sum-product decoding. The decoding method used by the soft-in/soft-out decoder may also be, for example, the BCJR algorithm, SOVA, and the Max-Log-Map algorithm. Details are provided in Non-Patent Literature 6.
In addition, although the present Embodiment is described using a single-carrier method, no limitation is intended in this regard. The present Embodiment is also applicable to multi-carrier transmission. Accordingly, the present Embodiment may also be realized using, for example, spread-spectrum communications, OFDM, SC-FDMA, SC-OFDM, wavelet OFDM as described in Non-Patent Literature 7, and so on. Furthermore, in the present Embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, and so on) or symbols transmitting control information, may be arranged within the frame in any manner.
The following describes an example in which OFDM is used as a multi-carrier method.
An OFDM-related processor 1201A takes weighted signal 309A as input, performs OFDM-related processing thereon, and outputs transmit signal 1202A. Similarly, OFDM-related processor 1201B takes post-phase change signal 309B as input, performs OFDM-related processing thereon, and outputs transmit signal 1202B.
Serial-to-parallel converter 1302A performs serial-to-parallel conversion on switched baseband signal 1301A (corresponding to switched baseband signal 6701A from
Reorderer 1304A takes parallel signal 1303A as input, performs reordering thereof, and outputs reordered signal 1305A. Reordering is described in detail later.
IFFT unit 1306A takes reordered signal 1305A as input, applies an IFFT thereto, and outputs post-IFFT signal 1307A.
Wireless unit 1308A takes post-IFFT signal 1307A as input, performs processing such as frequency conversion and amplification, thereon, and outputs modulated signal 1309A. Modulated signal 1309A is then output as radio waves by antenna 1310A.
Serial-to-parallel converter 1302B performs serial-to-parallel conversion on post-phase change 1301B (corresponding to post-phase change 309B from
Reorderer 1304B takes parallel signal 1303B as input, performs reordering thereof, and outputs reordered signal 1305B. Reordering is described in detail later.
IFFT unit 1306B takes reordered signal 1305B as input, applies an IFFT thereto, and outputs post-IFFT signal 1307B.
Wireless unit 1308B takes post-IFFT signal 1307B as input, performs processing such as frequency conversion and amplification thereon, and outputs modulated signal 1309B. Modulated signal 1309B is then output as radio waves by antenna 1310A.
The transmission device from
As shown in
Similarly, with respect to the symbols of weighted signal 1301B input to serial-to-parallel converter 1302B, the assigned ordering is #0, #1, #2, #3, and so on. Here, given that the example deals with a period (cycle) of four, a different change in phase is applied to each of #0, #1, #2, and #3, which are equivalent to one period (cycle). Similarly, a different change in phase is applied to each of #4n, #4n+1, #4n+2, and #4n+3 (n being a non-zero positive integer), which are also equivalent to one period (cycle).
As shown in
The symbol group 1402 shown in
In the present Embodiment, modulated signal z1 shown in
As such, when using a multi-carrier transmission method such as OFDM, and unlike single carrier transmission, symbols can be arranged in the frequency domain. Of course, the symbol arrangement method is not limited to those illustrated by
While
In
Here, symbol #0 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u, symbol #1 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+1, symbol #2 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+2, and symbol #3 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+3.
Similarly, for frequency-domain symbol group 2220, symbol #4 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u, symbol #5 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+1, symbol #6 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+2, and symbol #7 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+3.
The above-described change of phase is applied to the symbol at timestamp $1. However, in order to apply periodic shifting with respect to the time domain, the following change of phases are applied to symbol groups 2201, 2202, 2203, and 2204.
For time-domain symbol group 2201, symbol #0 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u, symbol #9 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+1, symbol #18 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+2, and symbol #27 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+3.
For time-domain symbol group 2202, symbol #28 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u, symbol #1 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+1, symbol #10 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+2, and symbol #19 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+3.
For time-domain symbol group 2203, symbol #20 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u, symbol #29 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+1, symbol #2 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+2, and symbol #11 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+3.
For time-domain symbol group 2204, symbol #12 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u, symbol #21 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+1, symbol #30 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+2, and symbol #3 is obtained through a change of phase at timestamp u+3.
The characteristic feature of
Although
Although the present Embodiment describes a variation of Embodiment 1 in which a baseband signal switcher is inserted before the change of phase, the present Embodiment may also be realized as a combination with Embodiment 2, such that the baseband signal switcher is inserted before the change of phase in
The following describes a method of allowing the reception device to obtain good received signal quality for data, regardless of the reception device arrangement, by considering the location of the reception device with respect to the transmission device.
Consider symbol 3100 at carrier 2 and timestamp $2 of
Within carrier 2, there is a very strong correlation between the channel conditions for symbol 3100A at carrier 2, timestamp $2 and the channel conditions for the time domain nearest-neighbour symbols to timestamp $2, i.e., symbol 3013 at timestamp $1 and symbol 3101 at timestamp $3 within carrier 2.
Similarly, for timestamp $2, there is a very strong correlation between the channel conditions for symbol 3100 at carrier 2, timestamp $2 and the channel conditions for the frequency-domain nearest-neighbour symbols to carrier 2, i.e., symbol 3104 at carrier 1, timestamp $2 and symbol 3104 at timestamp $2, carrier 3.
As described above, there is a very strong correlation between the channel conditions for symbol 3100 and the channel conditions for each symbol 3101, 3102, 3103, and 3104.
The present description considers N different phases (N being an integer, N≧2) for multiplication in a transmission method where the phase is regularly changed. The symbols illustrated in
The present Embodiment takes advantage of the high correlation in channel conditions existing between neighbouring symbols in the frequency domain and/or neighbouring symbols in the time domain in a symbol arrangement enabling high data reception quality to be obtained by the reception device receiving the post-phase change symbols.
In order to achieve this high data reception quality, conditions #D1-1 and #D1-2 are met.
(Condition #D1-1)
As shown in
(Condition #D1-2)
As shown in
Ideally, a data symbol should satisfy Condition #D1-1. Similarly, the data symbols should satisfy Condition #D1-2.
The reasons supporting Conditions #D1-1 and #D1-2 are as follows.
A very strong correlation exists between the channel conditions of given symbol of a transmit signal (hereinafter, symbol A) and the channel conditions of the symbols neighbouring symbol A in the time domain, as described above.
Accordingly, when three neighbouring symbols in the time domain each have different phases, then despite reception quality degradation in the LOS environment (poor signal quality caused by degradation in conditions due to phase relations despite high signal quality in terms of SNR) for symbol A, the two remaining symbols neighbouring symbol A are highly likely to provide good reception quality. As a result, good received signal quality is achievable after error correction and decoding.
Similarly, a very strong correlation exists between the channel conditions of given symbol of a transmit signal (symbol A) and the channel conditions of the symbols neighbouring symbol A in the frequency domain, as described above.
Accordingly, when three neighbouring symbols in the frequency domain each have different phases, then despite reception quality degradation in the LOS environment (poor signal quality caused by degradation in conditions due to direct wave phase relationships despite high signal quality in terms of SNR) for symbol A, the two remaining symbols neighbouring symbol A are highly likely to provide good reception quality. As a result, good received signal quality is achievable after error correction and decoding.
By combining Conditions #D1-1 and #D1-2, ever greater data reception quality is likely achievable for the reception device. Accordingly, the following Condition #D1-3 can be derived.
(Condition #D1-3)
As shown in
Here, the different changes in phase are as follows. Phase changes are defined from 0 radians to 2t radians. For example, for time X, carrier Y, a phase change of ejθX,Y is applied to precoded baseband signal q2 from
Ideally, a data symbol should satisfy Condition #D1-3.
As evident from
In other words, in
Similarly, in
Similarly, in
The following discusses the above-described example for a case where the change of phase is performed on two switched baseband signals q1 and q2 (see
Several phase changing methods are applicable to performing a change of phase on two switched baseband signals q1 and q2. The details thereof are explained below.
Scheme 1 involves a change in phase of switched baseband signal q2 as described above, to achieve the change in phase illustrated by
The symbols illustrated in
As shown in
As described above, the change in phase performed on switched baseband signal q2 has a period (cycle) of ten, but the period (cycle) can be effectively made greater than ten by taking the degree of phase change applied to switched baseband signal q1 and to switched baseband signal q2 into consideration. Accordingly, data reception quality may be improved for the reception device.
Scheme 2 involves a change in phase of switched baseband signal q2 as described above, to achieve the change in phase illustrated by
The symbols illustrated in
As described above, the change in phase performed on switched baseband signal q2 has a period (cycle) of ten, but the period (cycle) can be effectively made greater than ten by taking the changes in phase applied to switched baseband signal q1 and to switched baseband signal q2 into consideration. Accordingly, data reception quality may be improved for the reception device. An effective way of applying method 2 is to perform a change in phase on switched baseband signal q1 with a period (cycle) of N and perform a change in phase on precoded baseband signal q2 with a period (cycle) of M such that N and M are coprime. As such, by taking both switched baseband signals q1 and q2 into consideration, a period (cycle) of N×M is easily achievable, effectively making the period (cycle) greater when N and M are coprime.
While the above discusses an example of the above-described phase changing method, the present invention is not limited in this manner. The change in phase may be performed with respect to the frequency domain, the time domain, or on time-frequency blocks. Similar improvement to the data reception quality can be obtained for the reception device in all cases.
The same also applies to frames having a configuration other than that described above, where pilot symbols (SP symbols) and symbols transmitting control information are inserted among the data symbols. The details of the change in phase in such circumstances are as follows.
The important point of
The important point of
The important point of
The important point of
In
In
Although not indicated in the frame configurations from
Wireless units 310A and 310B of
A selector 5301 takes the plurality of baseband signals as input and selects a baseband signal having a symbol indicated by the frame configuration signal 313 for output.
Similarly, as shown in
The above explanations are given using pilot symbols, control symbols, and data symbols as examples. However, the present invention is not limited in this manner. When symbols are transmitted using methods other than precoding, such as single-antenna transmission or transmission using space-time block coding, the absence of change in phase is important. Conversely, performing the change of phase on symbols that have been precoded is the key point of the present invention.
Accordingly, a characteristic feature of the present invention is that the change in phase is not performed on all symbols within the frame configuration in the time-frequency domain, but only performed on baseband signals that have been precoded and have undergone switching.
The following describes a scheme for regularly changing the phase when encoding is performed using block codes as described in Non-Patent Literature 12 through 15, such as QC LDPC Codes (not only QC-LDPC but also LDPC codes may be used), concatenated LDPC and BCH codes, Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, and so on. The following example considers a case where two streams s1 and s2 are transmitted. When encoding has been performed using block codes and control information and the like is not necessary, the number of bits making up each coded block matches the number of bits making up each block code (control information and so on described below may yet be included). When encoding has been performed using block codes or the like and control information or the like (e.g., CRC transmission parameters) is required, then the number of bits making up each coded block is the sum of the number of bits making up the block codes and the number of bits making up the information.
As shown in
Then, given that the above-described transmission device transmits two streams simultaneously, 1500 of the aforementioned 3000 symbols needed when the modulation scheme is QPSK are assigned to s1 and the other 1500 symbols are assigned to s2. As such, 1500 slots for transmitting the 1500 symbols (hereinafter, slots) are required for each of s1 and s2.
By the same reasoning, when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, 750 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up two coded blocks, and when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, 500 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up the two coded blocks.
The following describes the relationship between the above-defined slots and the phase of multiplication, as pertains to methods for a regular change of phase.
Here, five different phase changing values (or phase changing sets) are assumed as having been prepared for use in the method for a regular change of phase. That is, the phase changer of the above-described transmission device uses five phase changing values (or phase changing sets) to achieve the period (cycle) of five. (As in
For the above-described 1500 slots needed to transmit the 6000 bits making up a single coded block when the modulation scheme is QPSK, PHASE[0] is used on 300 slots, PHASE[1] is used on 300 slots, PHASE[2] is used on 300 slots, PHASE[3] is used on 300 slots, and PHASE[4] is used on 300 slots. This is due to the fact that any bias in phase usage causes great influence to be exerted by the more frequently used phase, and that the reception device is dependent on such influence for data reception quality.
Furthermore, for the above-described 750 slots needed to transmit the 6000 bits making up a single coded block when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, PHASE[0] is used on 150 slots, PHASE[1] is used on 150 slots, PHASE[2] is used on 150 slots, PHASE[3] is used on 150 slots, and PHASE[4] is used on 150 slots.
Further still, for the above-described 500 slots needed to transmit the 6000 bits making up a single coded block when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, PHASE[0] is used on 100 slots, PHASE[1] is used on 100 slots, PHASE[2] is used on 100 slots, PHASE[3] is used on 100 slots, and PHASE[4] is used on 100 slots.
As described above, a scheme for a regular change of phase requires the preparation of N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) (where the N different phases are expressed as PHASE[0], PHASE[1], PHASE[2] . . . PHASE[N−2], PHASE[N−1]). As such, in order to transmit all of the bits making up a single coded block, PHASE[0] is used on K0 slots, PHASE[1] is used on K1 slots, PHASE[i] is used on Ki slots (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (i being an integer between 0 and N−1)), and PHASE[N−1] is used on KN-1 slots, such that Condition #D1-4 is met.
(Condition #D1-4)
K0=K1 . . . =Ki= . . . KN-1. That is, Ka=Kb (for ∀a and ∀b where a, b, =0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b).
Then, when a communication system that supports multiple modulation schemes selects one such supported method for use, Conditions #D1-4 is preferably met for the supported modulation scheme.
However, when multiple modulation schemes are supported, each such modulation scheme typically uses symbols transmitting a different number of bits per symbols (though some may happen to use the same number), Condition #D1-4 may not be satisfied for some modulation schemes. In such a case, the following condition applies instead of Condition #D1-4.
(Condition #D1-5)
The difference between Ka and Kb satisfies 0 or 1. That is, |Ka−Kb| satisfies 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b)
As shown in
The transmission device from
By the same reasoning, when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, 1500 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up the two coded blocks, and when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, 1000 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up the two coded blocks
The following describes the relationship between the above-defined slots and the phase of multiplication, as pertains to methods for a regular change of phase.
Here, five different phase changing values (or phase changing sets) are assumed as having been prepared for use in the method for a regular change of phase. That is, the phase changer of the transmission device from
For the above-described 3000 slots needed to transmit the 6000×2 bits making up the two coded blocks when the modulation scheme is QPSK, PHASE[0] is used on 600 slots, PHASE[1] is used on 600 slots, PHASE[2] is used on 600 slots, PHASE[3] is used on 600 slots, and PHASE[4] is used on 600 slots. This is due to the fact that any bias in phase usage causes great influence to be exerted by the more frequently used phase, and that the reception device is dependent on such influence for data reception quality.
Furthermore, in order to transmit the first coded block, PHASE[0] is used on slots 600 times, PHASE[1] is used on slots 600 times, PHASE[2] is used on slots 600 times, PHASE[3] is used on slots 600 times, and PHASE[4] is used on slots 600 times. Furthermore, in order to transmit the second coded block, PHASE[0] is used on slots 600 times, PHASE[1] is used on slots 600 times, PHASE[2] is used on slots 600 times, PHASE[3] is used on slots 600 times, and PHASE[4] is used on slots 600 times.
Similarly, for the above-described 1500 slots needed to transmit the 6000×2 bits making up the two coded blocks when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, PHASE[0] is used on 300 slots, PHASE[1] is used on 300 slots, PHASE[2] is used on 300 slots, PHASE[3] is used on 300 slots, and PHASE[4] is used on 300 slots.
Furthermore, in order to transmit the first coded block, PHASE[0] is used on slots 300 times, PHASE[1] is used on slots 300 times, PHASE[2] is used on slots 300 times, PHASE[3] is used on slots 300 times, and PHASE[4] is used on slots 300 times. Furthermore, in order to transmit the second coded block, PHASE[0] is used on slots 300 times, PHASE[1] is used on slots 300 times, PHASE[2] is used on slots 300 times, PHASE[3] is used on slots 300 times, and PHASE[4] is used on slots 300 times.
Similarly, for the above-described 1000 slots needed to transmit the 6000×2 bits making up the two coded blocks when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, PHASE[0] is used on 200 slots, PHASE[1] is used on 200 slots, PHASE[2] is used on 200 slots, PHASE[3] is used on 200 slots, and PHASE[4] is used on 200 slots.
Furthermore, in order to transmit the first coded block, PHASE[0] is used on slots 200 times, PHASE[1] is used on slots 200 times, PHASE[2] is used on slots 200 times, PHASE[3] is used on slots 200 times, and PHASE[4] is used on slots 200 times. Furthermore, in order to transmit the second coded block, PHASE[0] is used on slots 200 times, PHASE[1] is used on slots 200 times, PHASE[2] is used on slots 200 times, PHASE[3] is used on slots 200 times, and PHASE[4] is used on slots 200 times.
As described above, a method for a regular change of phase requires the preparation of N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) (where the N different phases are expressed as PHASE[0], PHASE[1], PHASE[2] . . . PHASE[N−2], PHASE[N−2]). As such, in order to transmit all of the bits making up a single coded block, PHASE[0] is used on K0 slots, PHASE[1] is used on K1 slots, PHASE[i] is used on Ki slots (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (i being an integer between 0 and N−1)), and PHASE[N−1] is used on KN-1 slots, such that Condition #D1-6 is met.
(Condition #D1-6)
K0=K1 . . . =Ki= . . . KN-1. That is, Ka=Kb (for ∀a and ∀b where a, b, =0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b).
Further, in order to transmit all of the bits making up the first coded block, PHASE[0] is used K0,1 times, PHASE[1] is used K1,1 times, PHASE[i] is used Ki,1 times (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (i being an integer between 0 and N−1)), and PHASE[N−1] is used KN-1,1 times, such that Condition #D1-7 is met.
(Condition #D1-7)
K0,1=K1,1= . . . Ki,1= . . . KN-1,1. That is, Ka,1=Kb,1 (∀a and ∀b where a, b, =0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b).
Furthermore, in order to transmit all of the bits making up the second coded block, PHASE[0] is used K0,2 times, PHASE[1] is used K1,2 times, PHASE[i] is used Ki,2 times (where i=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (i being an integer between 0 and N−1)), and PHASE[N−1] is used KN-1,2 times, such that Condition #D1-8 is met.
(Condition #D1-8)
K0,2=K1,2= . . . Ki,2= . . . KN-1,2. That is, Ka,2=Kb,2 (∀a and ∀b where a, b, =0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b).
Then, when a communication system that supports multiple modulation schemes selects one such supported method for use, Condition #D1-6 Condition #D1-7, and Condition #D1-8 is met for the supported modulation scheme.
However, when multiple modulation schemes are supported, each such modulation scheme typically uses symbols transmitting a different number of bits per symbols (though some may happen to use the same number), Condition #D1-6 Condition #D1-7, and Condition #D1-8 may not be satisfied for some modulation schemes. In such a case, the following conditions apply instead of Condition #D1-6 Condition #D1-7, and Condition #D1-8.
(Condition #D1-9)
The difference between Ka and Kb satisfies 0 or 1. That is, |Ka−Kb| satisfies 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b)
(Condition #D1-10)
The difference between Ka,1 and Kb,1 satisfies 0 or 1. That is, |Ka,1−Kb,1| satisfies 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b)
(Condition #D1-11)
The difference between Ka,2 and Kb,2 satisfies 0 or 1. That is, |Ka,2−Kb,2| satisfies 0 or 1 (∀a, ∀b, where a, b=0, 1, 2 . . . N−1 (a and b being integers between 0 and N−1), a≠b)
As described above, bias among the phases being used to transmit the coded blocks is removed by creating a relationship between the coded block and the phase of multiplication. As such, data reception quality may be improved for the reception device.
As described above, N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) are needed in order to perform a change of phase having a period (cycle) of N with the method for the regular change of phase. As such, N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) PHASE[0], PHASE[1], PHASE[2] . . . PHASE[N−2], and PHASE[N−1] are prepared. However, schemes exist for ordering the phases in the stated order with respect to the frequency domain. No limitation is intended in this regard. The N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) PHASE[0], PHASE[1], PHASE[2] . . . PHASE[N−2], and PHASE[N−1] may also change the phases of blocks in the time domain or in the time-frequency domain to obtain a symbol arrangement. Although the above examples discuss a phase changing method with a period (cycle) of N, the same effects are obtainable using N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) at random. That is, the N phase changing values (or phase changing sets) need not always have regular periodicity. As long as the above-described conditions are satisfied, great quality data reception improvements are realizable for the reception device.
Furthermore, given the existence of modes for spatial multiplexing MIMO methods, MIMO methods using a fixed precoding matrix, space-time block coding methods, single-stream transmission, and methods using a regular change of phase, the transmission device (broadcaster, base station) may select any one of these transmission methods.
As described in Non-Patent Literature 3, spatial multiplexing MIMO methods involve transmitting signals s1 and s2, which are mapped using a selected modulation scheme, on each of two different antennas. MIMO methods using a fixed precoding matrix involve performing precoding only (with no change in phase). Further, space-time block coding methods are described in Non-Patent Literature 9, 16, and 17. Single-stream transmission methods involve transmitting signal s1, mapped with a selected modulation scheme, from an antenna after performing predetermined processing.
Schemes using multi-carrier transmission such as OFDM involve a first carrier group made up of a plurality of carriers and a second carrier group made up of a plurality of carriers different from the first carrier group, and so on, such that multi-carrier transmission is realized with a plurality of carrier groups. For each carrier group, any of spatial multiplexing MIMO methods, MIMO methods using a fixed precoding matrix, space-time block coding methods, single-stream transmission, and methods using a regular change of phase may be used. In particular, methods using a regular change of phase on a selected (sub-)carrier group are preferably used to realize the above.
Although the present description describes the present Embodiment as a transmission device applying precoding, baseband switching, and change in phase, all of these may be variously combined. In particular, the phase changer discussed for the present Embodiment may be freely combined with the change in phase discussed in all other Embodiments.
The present Embodiment describes a phase change initialization method for the regular change of phase described throughout the present description. This initialization method is applicable to the transmission device from
The following is also applicable to a method of regularly changing the phase when encoding is performed using block codes as described in Non-Patent Literature 12 through 15, such as QC LDPC Codes (not only QC-LDPC but also LDPC codes may be used), concatenated LDPC and BCH codes, Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, and so on.
The following example considers a case where two streams s1 and s2 are transmitted. When encoding has been performed using block codes and control information and the like is not necessary, the number of bits making up each coded block matches the number of bits making up each block code (control information and so on described below may yet be included). When encoding has been performed using block codes or the like and control information or the like (e.g., CRC transmission parameters) is required, then the number of bits making up each coded block is the sum of the number of bits making up the block codes and the number of bits making up the information.
As shown in
Then, given that the above-described transmission device transmits two streams simultaneously, 1500 of the aforementioned 3000 symbols needed when the modulation scheme is QPSK are assigned to s1 and the other 1500 symbols are assigned to s2. As such, 1500 slots for transmitting the 1500 symbols (hereinafter, slots) are required for each of s1 and s2.
By the same reasoning, when the modulation scheme is 16-QAM, 750 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up each coded block, and when the modulation scheme is 64-QAM, 500 slots are needed to transmit all of the bits making up each coded block.
The following describes a transmission device transmitting modulated signals having a frame configuration illustrated by
As shown in
Further, the transmission device transmits a preamble (control symbol) during interval D. The preamble is a symbol transmitting control information for another party. In particular, this preamble includes information on the modulation scheme used to transmit a third or fourth coded block and so on. The transmission device transmits the third coded block during interval E. The transmission device then transmits the fourth coded block during interval D.
Also, as shown in
Further, the transmission device transmits a preamble (control symbol) during interval D. The preamble is a symbol transmitting control information for another party. In particular, this preamble includes information on the modulation scheme used to transmit a third or fourth coded block and so on. The transmission device transmits the third coded block during interval E. The transmission device then transmits the fourth coded block during interval D.
Similarly,
As explained throughout this description, modulated signal z1, i.e., the modulated signal transmitted by antenna 312A, does not undergo a change in phase, while modulated signal z2, i.e., the modulated signal transmitted by antenna 312B, does undergo a change in phase. The following phase changing method is used for
Before the change in phase can occur, seven different phase changing values must prepared. The seven phase changing values are labelled #0, #1, #2, #3, #4, #5, and #6. The change in phase is regular and periodic. In other words, the phase changing values are applied regularly and periodically, such that the order is #0, #1, #2, #3, #4, #5, #6, #0, #1, #2, #3, #4, #5, #6, #0, #1, #2, #3, #4, #5, #6 and so on.
As shown in
The change in phase is then applied to each slot for the second coded block. The present description assumes multi-cast transmission and broadcasting applications. As such, a receiving terminal may have no need for the first coded block and extract only the second coded block. In such circumstances, given that the final slot used for the first coded block uses phase changing value #0, the initial phase changing value used for the second coded block is #1. As such, the following methods are conceivable:
(a): The aforementioned terminal monitors the transmission of the first coded block, i.e., monitors the pattern of the phase changing values through the final slot used to transmit the first coded block, and then estimates the phase changing value used for the initial slot of the second coded block;
(b): (a) does not occur, and the transmission device transmits information on the phase changing values in use at the initial slot of the second coded block. Scheme (a) leads to greater energy consumption by the terminal due to the need to monitor the transmission of the first coded block. However, scheme (b) leads to reduced data transmission efficiency.
Accordingly, there is a need to improve the phase changing value allocation described above. Consider a method in which the phase changing value used to transmit the initial slot of each coded block is fixed. Thus, as indicated in
Similarly, as indicated in
As such, the problems accompanying both methods (a) and (b) described above can be constrained while retaining the effects thereof.
In the present Embodiment, the method used to initialize the phase changing value for each coded block, i.e., the phase changing value used for the initial slot of each coded block, is fixed so as to be #0. However, other methods may also be used for single-frame units. For example, the phase changing value used for the initial slot of a symbol transmitting information after the preamble or control symbol has been transmitted may be fixed at #0.
The above-described Embodiments discuss a weighting unit using a precoding matrix expressed in complex numbers for precoding. However, the precoding matrix may also be expressed in real numbers.
That is, suppose that two baseband signals s1(i) and s2(i) (where i is time or frequency) have been mapped (using a modulation scheme), and precoded to obtained precoded baseband signals z1(i) and z2(i). As such, mapped baseband signal s1(i) has an in-phase component of Is1(i) and a quadrature component of Qs1(i), and mapped baseband signal s2(i) has an in-phase component of Is2(i) and a quadrature component of Qs2(i), while precoded baseband signal z1(i) has an in-phase component of Iz1(i) and a quadrature component of Qz1(i), and precoded baseband signal z2(i) has an in-phase component of Iz2(i) and a quadrature component of Qz2(i), which gives the following precoding matrix Hr when all values are real numbers.
Precoding matrix Hr may also be expressed as follows, where all values are real numbers.
where a11, a12, a13, a14, a21, a22, a23, a24, a31, a32, a33, a34, a41, a42, a43, and a44 are real numbers. However, none of the following may hold: {a11=0, a12=0, a13=0, and a14=0}, {a21=0, a22=0, a23=0, and a24=0}, {a31=0, a32=0, a33=0, and a34=0}, and {a41=0, a42=0, a43=0, and a44=0}. Also, none of the following may hold: {a11=0, a21=0, a31=0, and a41=0}, {a12=0, a22=0, a32=0, and a42=0}, {a13=0, a23=0, a33=0, and a43=0}, and {a14=0, a24=0, a34=0, and a44=0}.
The present Embodiment describes a transmission scheme as an application of the change in phase to precoded signals (or precoded signals having switched basebands) for a broadcasting system using the DVB-T2 (Digital Video Broadcasting for a second generation digital terrestrial television broadcasting system) standard. First, the configuration of a frame in a broadcasting system using the DVB-T2 standard is described.
The P1 signalling data (7401) is a symbol used by the reception device for signal detection and frequency synchronization (including frequency offset estimation), that simultaneously serves to transmit information such as the FFT size and whether the modulated signal is transmitted by a SISO or MISO method. (With SISO methods, only one modulated signal is transmitted, while with MISO methods, a plurality of modulated signals are transmitted. In addition, the space-time blocks described in Non-Patent Literature 9, 16, and 17 may be used.)
The L1 pre-signalling data (7402) is used to transmit information regarding the methods used to transmit the frame, concerning the guard interval, the signal processing method information used to reduce the PAPR (Peak-to-Average Power Ratio), the modulation scheme used to transmit the L1 post-signalling data, the FEC method, the coding rate thereof, the length and size of the L1 post-signalling data, them the payload pattern, the cell(frequency region)-specific numbers, and whether normal mode or extended mode is in use (where normal mode and extended mode differ in terms of sub-carrier numbers used to transmit data).
The L1 post-signalling data (7403) is used to transmit such information as the number of PLPs, the frequency region in use, the PLP-specific numbers, the modulation scheme used to transmit the PLPs, the FEC method, the coding rate thereof, the number of blocks transmitted by each PLP, and so on.
The common PLP (7404) and the PLPs #1 through #N (7405_1 through 7405_N) are areas used for data transmission.
The frame configuration from
A PLP signal generator 7602 takes PLP transmit data 7601 (data for the PLPs) and a control signal 7609 as input, performs error-correcting coding according to the error-correcting code information for the PLPs included in the control signal 7609 and performs mapping according to the modulation scheme similarly included in the control signal 7609, and then outputs a PLP (quadrature) baseband signal 7603.
A P2 symbol signal generator 7605 takes P2 symbol transmit data 7604 and the control signal 7609 as input, performs error-correcting coding according to the error-correcting code information for the P2 symbol included in the control signal 7609 and performs mapping according to the modulation scheme similarly included in the control signal 7609, and then outputs a P2 symbol (quadrature) baseband signal 7606.
A control signal generator 7608 takes P1 symbol transmit data 7607 and the P2 symbol transmit data 7604 as input and outputs the control signal 7609 for the group of symbols from
A frame configurator 7610 takes a PLP baseband signal 7603, the P2 symbol baseband signal 7606, and the control signal 7609 as input, performs reordering with respect to the time and frequency domains according to the frame configuration information included in the control signal, and accordingly outputs (quadrature) baseband signal 7611_1 for stream 1 (a mapped signal, i.e., a baseband signal on which the modulation scheme has been used) and (quadrature) baseband signal 7611_2 for stream 2 (also a mapped signal, i.e., a baseband signal on which the modulation scheme has been used).
A signal processor 7612 takes the baseband signal for stream 1 7611_1, the baseband signal for stream 2 7611_2, and the control signal 7609 as input, and then outputs modulated signals 1 (7613_1) and 2 (7613_2), processed according to the transmission method included in the control signal 7609.
Here, the characteristic feature is that when the transmission method for performing the change of phase on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals is selected, the signal processor performs the change in phase on the precoded (or precoded and switched) signals as indicated in
A pilot inserter 7614_1 takes processed modulated signal 1 (7613_1) and control signal 7609 as input, inserts pilot symbols into processed modulated signal 1 (7613_1) according to the pilot symbol insertion method information included in the control signal 7609, and outputs a post-pilot symbol insertion modulated signal 7615_1.
Another pilot inserter 7614_2 takes processed modulated signal 2 (7613_2) and control signal 7609 as input, inserts pilot symbols into processed modulated signal 2 (7613_2) according to the pilot symbol insertion method information included in the control signal 7609, and outputs a post-pilot symbol insertion modulated signal 7615_2.
An IFFT unit 7616_1 takes post-pilot symbol insertion modulated signal 7615_1 and the control signal 7609 as input, applies an IFFT according to the IFFT method information included in the control signal 7609, and outputs post-IFFT signal 7617_1.
Another IFFT unit 7616_2 takes post-pilot symbol insertion modulated signal 7615_2 and the control signal 7609 as input, applies an IFFT according to the IFFT method information included in the control signal 7609, and outputs post-IFFT signal 7617_2.
PAPR reducer 7618_1 takes post-IFFT signal 7617_1 and control signal 7609 as input, applies PAPR-reducing processing to post-IFFT signal 7617_1 according to the PAPR reduction information included in the control signal 7609, and outputs post-PAPR reduction signal 7619_1.
PAPR reducer 7618_2 takes post-IFFT signal 7617_2 and control signal 7609 as input, applies PAPR-reducing processing to post-IFFT signal 7617_2 according to the PAPR reduction information included in the control signal 7609, and outputs post-PAPR reduction signal 7619_2.
Guard interval inserter 7620_1 takes post-PAPR reduction signal 7619_1 and the control signal 7609 as input, inserts guard intervals into post-PAPR reduction 7619_1 according to the guard interval insertion method information included in the control signal 7609, and outputs post-guard interval insertion signal 7621_1.
Guard interval inserter 7620_2 takes post-PAPR reduction signal 7619_2 and the control signal 7609 as input, inserts guard intervals into post-PAPR reduction 7619_2 according to the guard interval insertion method information included in the control signal 7609, and outputs post-guard interval insertion signal 7621_2.
A P1 symbol inserter 7622 takes the P1 symbol transmit data 7607 and the post-guard interval insertion signals 7621_1 and 7621_2 as input, generates P1 symbol signals from the P1 symbol transmit data 7607, adds the P1 symbols to the respective post-guard interval insertion signals 7621_1 and 7621_2, and outputs post-P1 symbol addition signals 7623_1 and 7623_2. The P1 symbol signals may be added to one or both of post-guard interval insertion signals 7621_1 and 7621_2. In the former case, the signal to which nothing is added has zero signals as the baseband signal in the interval to which the symbols are added to the other signal.
Wireless processor 7624_1 takes post-P1 symbol addition signal 7623_1 as input, performs processing such as frequency conversion and amplification thereon, and outputs transmit signal 7625_1. Transmit signal 7625_1 is then output as radio waves by antenna 7626_1.
Wireless processor 7624_2 takes post-P1 symbol addition signal 7623_2 as input, performs processing such as frequency conversion and amplification thereon, and outputs transmit signal 7625_2. Transmit signal 7625_2 is then output as radio waves by antenna 7626_2.
As shown in
Interval 2 is used to transmit symbol group 7702 of PLP#2 using stream s1. Data are transmitted using one modulated signal.
Interval 3 is used to transmit symbol group 7703 of PLP#3 using stream s1 and stream s2. Data are transmitted using a transmission method in which a change in phase is performed on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals.
Interval 4 is used to transmit symbol group 7704 using stream s1 and stream s2. Data are transmitted using the time-space block codes described in Non-Patent Literature 9, 16, and 17.
When a broadcaster transmits PLPs as illustrated by
Table 2 lists specific examples of control information carried by the P1 symbol.
TABLE 2
S1 (3-bit)
Control Information
000
T2_SISO
(transmission of one modulated signal in the
DVB-T2 standard)
001
T2_MISO
(transmission using time-space block codes in the
DVB-T2 standard)
010
NOT_T2
(using a standard other than DVB-T2)
In the DVB-T2 standard, S1 control information (three bits of data) is used by the reception device to determine whether or not DVB-T2 is being used, and in the affirmative case, to determine the transmission method.
As indicated in Table 2, above, the 3-bit S1 data are set to 000 to indicate that the modulated signals being transmitted conform to transmission of one modulated signal in the DVB-T2 standard.
Alternatively, the 3-bit S1 data are set to 001 to indicate that the modulated signals being transmitted conform to the use of time-space block codes in the DVB-T2 standard.
In DVB-T2, 010 through 111 are reserved for future use. In order to apply the present invention while maintaining compatibility with DVB-T2, the 3-bit S1 data should be set to 010, for example (anything other than 000 and 001 may be used), and should indicate that a standard other than DVB-T2 is being used for the modulated signals. Thus, the reception device or terminal is able to determine that the broadcaster is transmitting using modulated signals conforming to a standard other than DVB-T2 by detecting that the data read 010.
The following describes an example of a configuration method for a P2 symbol used when the modulated signals transmitted by the broadcaster conform to a standard other than DVB-T2. In the first example, a scheme of using the P2 symbol within the DVB-T2 standard.
Table 3 lists a first example of control information transmitted by the L1 post-signalling data in the P2 symbol.
TABLE 3
PLP_MODE (2-bits)
Control Information
00
SISO/MIMO
01
MISO/MIMO
(space-time block codes)
10
MIMO
(performing a change of phase on precoded
signals (or precoded signals having switched
basebands))
11
MIMO
(using a fixed precoding matrix, or using
spatial multiplexing)
The above-given tables use the following abbreviations.
SISO: Single-Input Single-Output (one modulated signal transmitted and received by one antenna)
SIMO: Single-Input Multiple-Output (one modulated signal transmitted and received by multiple antennas)
MISO: Multiple-Input Single-Output (multiple modulated signals transmitted by multiple antennas and received by a single antenna)
MIMO: Multiple-Input Multiple-Output (multiple modulated signals transmitted and received by multiple antennas)
The two-bit data listed in Table 3 are the PLP_MODE information. As shown in
When the PLP_MODE is set to 00, data are transmitted by that PLP using a method in which a single modulated signal is transmitted. When the PLP_MODE is set to 01, data are transmitted by that PLP using a method in which multiple modulated signals are transmitted using space-time block codes. When the PLP_MODE is set to 10, data are transmitted by that PLP using a method in which a change in phase is performed on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals. When the PLP_MODE is set to 11, data are transmitted by that PLP using a method in which a fixed precoding matrix is used, or in which a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, is used.
When the PLP_MODE is set to any of 01 through 11, the broadcaster must transmit the specific processing (e.g., the specific transmission method by which the change in phase is applied to precoded (or precoded and switched) signals, the encoding method of time-space block codes, or the configuration of the precoding matrix) to the terminal. The following describes an alternative to Table 3, as a configuration method for control information that includes the control information necessitated by such circumstances.
Table 4 lists a second example of control information transmitted by the L1 post-signalling data in the P2 symbol, different from that of Table 3.
TABLE 4
No.
Name
of bits
Control Information
PLP_MODE
0
SISO/SISO
(1-bit)
1
MIMO/MIMO, using one of
(i) space-time block codes;
(ii) change in phase performed on precoded
signals (or precoded signals having
switched basebands);
(iii) a fixed precoding matrix; and
(iv) spatial multiplexing
MIMO_MODE
0
change in phase on precoded signals (or
(1-bit)
precoded signals having switched
basebands) is OFF
1
change in phase on precoded signals (or
precoded signals having switched
basebands) is ON
MIMO_PATTERN#1
00
space-time block codes
(2-bit)
01
fixed precoding matrix #1
10
fixed precoding matrix #2
11
spatial multiplexing
MIMO_PATTERN#2
00
change in phase on precoded signals (or
(2-bit)
precoded signals having switched
basebands), version #1
01
change in phase on precoded signals (or
precoded signals having switched
basebands), version #2
10
change in phase on precoded signals (or
precoded signals having switched
basebands), version #3
11
change in phase on precoded signals (or
precoded signals having switched
basebands), version #4
As indicated in Table 4, four types of control information are possible: 1-bit PLP_MODE information, 1-bit MIMO_MODE information, 2-bit MIMO_PATTERN#1 information, and 2-bit MIMO_PATTERN#2 information. As shown in
When the PLP_MODE is set to 0, data are transmitted by that PLP using a method in which a single modulated signal is transmitted. When the PLP_MODE is set to 1, data are transmitted by that PLP using a method in which any one of the following applies: (i) space-time block codes are used; (ii) a MIMO system is used where a change in phase is performed on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals; (iii) a MIMO system is used where a fixed precoding matrix is used; and (iv) spatial multiplexing is used.
When the PLP_MODE is set to 1, the MIMO_MODE information is valid. When the MIMO_MODE information is set to 0, data are transmitted without using a change in phase performed on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals. When the MIMO_MODE information is set to 1, data are transmitted using a change in phase performed on precoded (or precoded signals having switched basebands).
When the PLP_MODE is set to 1 and the MIMO_MODE information is set to 0, the MIMO_PATTERN#1 information is valid. When the MIMO_PATTERN#1 information is set to 00, data are transmitted using space-time block codes. When the MIMO_PATTERN#1 information is set to 01, data are transmitted using fixed precoding matrix #1 for weighting. When the MIMO_PATTERN#1 information is set to 10, data are transmitted using fixed precoding matrix #2 for weighting. (Precoding matrix #1 and precoding matrix #2 are different matrices.) When the MIMO_PATTERN#1 information is set to 11, data are transmitted using spatial multiplexing MIMO.
When the PLP_MODE is set to 1 and the MIMO_MODE information is set to 1, the MIMO_PATTERN#2 information is valid. When the MIMO_PATTERN#2 information is set to 00, data are transmitted using version #1 of a change in phase on precoded (or precoded signals having switched basebands). When the MIMO_PATTERN#2 information is set to 01, data are transmitted using version #2 of a change in phase on precoded (or precoded signals having switched basebands). When the MIMO_PATTERN#2 information is set to 10, data are transmitted using version #3 of a change in phase on precoded (or precoded signals having switched basebands). When the MIMO_PATTERN#2 information is set to 11, data are transmitted using version #4 of a change in phase on precoded (or precoded signals having switched basebands). Although the change in phase is performed in four different versions #1 through 4, the following three approaches are possible, given two different methods #A and #B:
Phase changes performed using method #A and performed using method #B include identical and different changes.
A phase changing value included in method #A is not included in method #B; and
Multiple phase changes used in method #A are not included in method #B.
The control information listed in Table 3 and Table 4, above, is transmitted by the L1 post-signalling data in the P2 symbol. However, in the DVB-T2 standard, the amount of information transmittable as a P2 symbol is limited. Accordingly, the information listed in Tables 3 and 4 is added to the information transmitted by the P2 symbol in the DVB-T2 standard. When this leads to exceeding the limit on information transmittable as the P2 symbol, then as shown in
As described above, selecting a transmission method that uses a multi-carrier method such as OFDM and preserves compatibility with the DVB-T2 standard, and in which the change in phase is performed on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals has the merits of leading to better reception quality in the LOS environment and to greater transmission speeds. While the present invention describes the possible transmission methods for the carriers as being spatial multiplexing MIMO, MIMO using a fixed precoding matrix, a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, space-time block codes, and transmission methods transmitting only stream s1, no limitation is intended in this manner.
Also, although the description indicates that the broadcaster selects one of the aforementioned transmission methods, these are not the only transmission methods available for selection. Other options include:
MIMO using a fixed precoding matrix, a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, space-time block codes, and transmission methods transmitting only stream s1;
MIMO using a fixed precoding matrix, a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, and space-time block codes;
MIMO using a fixed precoding matrix, a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, and transmission methods transmitting only stream s1;
A transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, space-time block codes, and transmission methods transmitting only stream s1;
MIMO using a fixed precoding matrix and a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals;
A transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals and space-time block codes;
A transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals and transmission methods transmitting only stream s1.
As such, by including a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, the merits of leading to greater data transmission speeds in the LOS environment and better reception quality for the reception device are achieved.
Here, given that, as described above, S1 needs to be set for the P1 symbol, another configuration method for the control information (regarding the transmission method for each PLP), different from that of Table 3, is possible. For example, Table 5, below.
TABLE 5
PLP_MODE (2-bit)
Control Information
00
SISO/MIMO
01
MISO/MIMO
(space-time block codes)
10
MIMO
(change in phase on precoded signals
(or precoded signals having switched basebands))
11
Reserved
Table 5 differs from Table 3 in that setting the PLP_MODE information to 11 is reserved. As such, when the transmission method for the PLPs is as described in one of the above examples, the number of bits forming the PLP_MODE information as in the examples of Tables 3 and 5 may be made greater or smaller according to the transmission methods available for selection.
Similarly, for Table 4, when, for example, a MIMO method is used with a transmission method that does not support changing the phase of precoded signals (or precoded signals having switched basebands), the MIMO_MODE control information is not necessary. Also, when, for example, MIMO schemes using a fixed precoding matrix are not supported, then the MIMO_PATTERN#1 is not necessary. Also, when multiple precoding matrices are not necessary, 1-bit information may be used instead of 2-bit information. Furthermore, two or more bits may be used when a plurality of precoding matrices are available.
The same principles apply to the MIMO_PATTERN#2 information. When the transmission method does not require a plurality of methods of performing a change of phase on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals, 1-bit information may be used instead of 2-bit information. Furthermore, two or more bits may be used when a plurality of phase changing schemes are available.
Furthermore, although the present Embodiment describes a transmission device having two antennas, no limitation is intended in this regard. The control information may also be transmitted using more than two antennas. In such circumstances, the number of bits in each type of control information may be increased as required in order to realize transmission using four antennas. The above description control information transmission in the P1 and P2 symbol also applies to such cases.
While
Unlike
In
As described above,
Although, for the sake of simplicity,
Unlike
Accordingly, in
Unlike
In
Although, for the sake of simplicity,
Thus, given that the T2 frame includes no PLPs using transmission methods transmitting only stream s1, the dynamic range of the signals received by the terminal may be constrained, which is likely to lead to improved received signal quality.
Although
selecting one of transmitting data using a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, transmitting data using space-time block codes, and transmitting data using a MIMO system using a fixed precoding matrix;
selecting one of transmitting data using a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, and transmitting data using space-time block codes; and
selecting one of transmitting data using a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals and transmitting data using a MIMO system using a fixed precoding matrix.
While the above explanation is given for a T2 frame having multiple PLPs, the following describes a T2 frame having only one PLP.
Furthermore, the first T2 frame in
The second T2 frame transmits symbol group 8102 of PLP#2-1. The transmission method is transmission using a single modulated signal.
The third T2 frame transmits symbol group 8103 of PLP#3-1. The transmission method is transmission performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals.
The fourth T2 frame transmits symbol group 8104 of PLP#4-1. The transmission method is transmission using space-time block codes.
In
As such, the transmission method may be set by taking the data transmission speed and the data reception speed of the terminal into consideration for each PLP. This has the dual merits of allowing the data transmission speed to be enhanced and ensuring high data reception quality. The configuration method for the control information pertaining to the transmission method and so on for the P1 and P2 symbols (and the signalling PLP, where applicable) may be as given by Tables 2 through 5, thus obtaining the same effects.
Although the above description discusses methods of transmitting information pertaining to the transmission method of PLPs using P1 and P2 symbols (and the signalling PLP, where applicable), the following describes a method of transmitting information pertaining to the transmission method of PLPs without using the P2 symbol.
The P1 signalling data (7401) are a symbol used for signal reception by the reception device and for frequency synchronization (including frequency offset estimation). In addition, these data transmit identification regarding whether or not the frame conforms to the DVB-T2 standard, e.g., using the S1 data as indicated in Table 2 for this purpose.
The first signalling data (8301) are used to transmit information regarding the methods used to transmit the frame, concerning the guard interval, the signal processing method information used to reduce the PAPR, the modulation scheme used to transmit the L1 post-signalling data, the FEC method, the coding rate thereof, the length and size of the L1 post-signalling data, them the payload pattern, the cell(frequency region)-specific numbers, and whether normal mode or extended mode is in use, and other such information. Here, the first signalling data (8301) need not necessarily be data conforming to the DVB-T2 standard.
The second signalling data (8302) is used to transmit such information as the number of PLPs, the frequency region in use, the PLP-specific numbers, the modulation scheme used to transmit the PLPs, the FEC method, the coding rate thereof, the number of blocks transmitted by each PLP, and so on.
The frame configuration from
A control signal generator 7608 takes first and second signalling data 8501 and P1 symbol transmit data 7607 as input, and outputs the control signal 7609 (made up of such information as the error-correcting codes and coding rate therefor, the modulation scheme, the block length, the frame configuration, the selected transmission method in which the precoding matrix is regularly changed, the pilot symbol insertion method, IFFT/FFT information, the PAPR reduction method, and the guard interval insertion method) for the transmission method of each symbol group of
A control symbol signal generator 8502 takes the first and second signalling data transmit data 8501 and the control signal 7609 as input, performs error-correcting coding according to the error-correcting code information for the first and second signalling data included in the control signal 7609 and performs mapping according to the modulation scheme similarly included in the control signal 7609, and then outputs a first and second signalling data (quadrature) baseband signal 8503.
In
The following describes, with reference to
As shown in
Interval 2 is used to transmit symbol group 7702 of PLP#2 using stream s1. Data are transmitted using one modulated signal.
Interval 3 is used to transmit symbol group 7703 of PLP#3 using stream s1 and stream s2. Data are transmitted using a transmission method in which a change in phase is performed on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals.
Interval 4 is used to transmit symbol group 7704 of PLP#4 using stream s1 and stream s2. Data are transmitted using the time-space block codes.
When a broadcaster transmits PLPs as illustrated by
In the DVB-T2 standard, S1 control information (three bits of data) is used by the reception device to determine whether or not DVB-T2 is being used, and in the affirmative case, to determine the transmission method. The 3-bit S1 data are set to 000 to indicate that the modulated signals being transmitted conform to transmission of one modulated signal in the DVB-T2 standard.
Alternatively, the 3-bit S1 data are set to 001 to indicate that the modulated signals being transmitted conform to the use of time-space block codes in the DVB-T2 standard.
In DVB-T2, 010 through 111 are reserved for future use. In order to apply the present invention while maintaining compatibility with DVB-T2, the 3-bit S1 data should be set to 010, for example (anything other than 000 and 001 may be used), and should indicate that a standard other than DVB-T2 is being used for the modulated signals. Thus, the reception device or terminal is able to determine that the broadcaster is transmitting using modulated signals conforming to a standard other than DVB-T2 by detecting that the data read 010.
The following describes a configuration method for the first and second signalling data used when the modulated signals transmitted by the broadcaster do not conform to the DVB-T2 standard. A second example of control information for the first and second signalling data is given by Table 3.
The two-bit data listed in Table 3 are the PLP_MODE information. As shown in
When the PLP_MODE is set to 00, data are transmitted by that PLP using a method in which a single modulated signal is transmitted. When the PLP_MODE is set to 01, data are transmitted by that PLP using a method in which multiple modulated signals are transmitted using space-time block codes. When the PLP_MODE is set to 10, data are transmitted by that PLP using a method in which a change in phase is performed on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals. When the PLP_MODE is set to 11, data are transmitted by that PLP using a method in which a fixed precoding matrix is used, or in which a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, is used.
When the PLP_MODE is set to any of 01 through 11, the broadcaster must transmit the specific processing (e.g., the specific transmission method by which a change in phase is applied to precoded (or precoded and switched) signals, the encoding method of time-space block codes, or the configuration of the precoding matrix) to the terminal. The following describes an alternative to Table 3, as a configuration method for control information that includes the control information necessitated by such circumstances.
A second example of control information for the first and second signalling data is given by Table 4.
As indicated in Table 4, four types of control information are possible: 1-bit PLP_MODE information, 1-bit MIMO_MODE information, 2-bit MIMO_PATTERN#1 information, and 2-bit MIMO_PATTERN#2 information. As shown in
When the PLP_MODE is set to 0, data are transmitted by that PLP using a method in which a single modulated signal is transmitted. When the PLP_MODE is set to 1, data are transmitted by that PLP using a method in which any one of the following applies: (i) space-time block codes are used; (ii) a MIMO system is used where a change in phase is performed on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals; (iii) a MIMO system is used where a fixed precoding matrix is used; and (iv) spatial multiplexing is used.
When the PLP_MODE is set to 1, the MIMO_MODE information is valid. When the MIMO_MODE information is set to 0, data are transmitted without using a change in phase performed on recoded signals (or precoded signals having switched basebands). When the MIMO_MODE information is set to 1, data are transmitted using a change in phase performed on recoded signals (or precoded signals having switched basebands).
When the PLP_MODE information is set to 1 and the MIMO_MODE information is set to 0, the MIMO_PATTERN#1 information is valid. As such, when the MIMO_PATTERN#1 information is set to 00, data are transmitted using space-time block codes. When the MIMO_PATTERN#1 information is set to 01, data are transmitted using fixed precoding matrix #1 for weighting. When the MIMO_PATTERN#1 information is set to 10, data are transmitted using fixed precoding matrix #2 for weighting. (Precoding matrix #1 and precoding matrix #2 are different matrices.) When the MIMO_PATTERN#1 information is set to 11, data are transmitted using spatial multiplexing MIMO.
When the PLP_MODE information is set to 1 and the MIMO_MODE information is set to 1, the MIMO_PATTERN#2 information is valid. When the MIMO_PATTERN#2 information is set to 00, data are transmitted using version #1 of a change in phase on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals. When the MIMO_PATTERN#2 information is set to 01, data are transmitted using version #2 of a change in phase on precoded (or precoded signals having switched basebands). When the MIMO_PATTERN#2 information is set to 10, data are transmitted using version #3 of a change in phase on precoded (or precoded signals having switched basebands). When the MIMO_PATTERN#2 information is set to 11, data are transmitted using version #4 of a change in phase on precoded (or precoded signals having switched basebands). Although the change in phase is performed in four different versions #1 through 4, the following three approaches are possible, given two different methods #A and #B:
Phase changes performed using method #A and performed using method #B include identical and different changes.
Some phase changing values are included in method #A but are not included in method #B; and
Multiple phase changes used in method #A are not included in method #B.
The control information listed in Table 3 and Table 4, above, is transmitted by the first and second signalling data. In such circumstances, there is no particular need to use the PLPs to transmit the control information.
As described above, selecting a transmission method that uses a multi-carrier method such as OFDM while being identifiable as differing from the DVB-T2 standard, and in which a change of phase is performed on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals has the merits of leading to better reception quality in the LOS environment and to greater transmission speeds. While the present invention describes the possible transmission methods for the carriers as being spatial multiplexing MIMO, MIMO using a fixed precoding matrix, a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, space-time block codes, and transmission methods transmitting only stream s1, no limitation is intended in this manner.
Also, although the description indicates that the broadcaster selects one of the aforementioned transmission methods, these are not the only transmission methods available for selection. Other options include:
MIMO using a fixed precoding matrix, a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, space-time block codes, and transmission methods transmitting only stream s1;
MIMO using a fixed precoding matrix, a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, and space-time block codes;
MIMO using a fixed precoding matrix, a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, and transmission methods transmitting only stream s1;
A transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, space-time block codes, and transmission methods transmitting only stream s1;
MIMO using a fixed precoding matrix and a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals;
A transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals and space-time block codes; and
A transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals and transmission methods transmitting only stream s1.
As such, by including a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, the merits of leading to greater data transmission speeds in the LOS environment and better reception quality for the reception device are achieved.
Here, given that, as described above, the S1 data is set for the P1 symbol, another configuration method for the control information (regarding the transmission method for each PLP) transmitted as the first and second signalling data, different from that of Table 3, is possible. For example, see Table 5, above.
Table 5 differs from Table 3 in that setting the PLP_MODE information to 11 is reserved. As such, when the transmission method for the PLPs is as described in one of the above examples, the number of bits forming the PLP_MODE information as in the examples of Tables 3 and 5 may be made greater or smaller according to the transmission methods available for selection.
Similarly, for Table 4, when, for example, a MIMO method is used with a transmission method that does not support changing the phase of precoded (or precoded and switched) signals, the MIMO_MODE control information is not necessary. Also, when, for example, MIMO schemes using a fixed precoding matrix are not supported, then the MIMO_PATTERN#1 is not necessary. Also, when multiple precoding matrices are not necessary, 1-bit information may be used instead of 2-bit information. Furthermore, two or more bits may be used when a plurality of precoding matrices are available.
The same principles apply to the MIMO_PATTERN#2 information. When the transmission schemes does not require a plurality of methods of performing a change of phase on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals, 1-bit information may be used instead of 2-bit information. Furthermore, two or more bits may be used when a plurality of phase changing schemes are available.
Furthermore, although the present Embodiment describes a transmission device having two antennas, no limitation is intended in this regard. The control information may also be transmitted using more than two antennas. In such circumstances, the number of bits in each type of control information may be increased as required in order to realize transmission using four antennas. The above description control information transmission in the P1 symbol and in the first and second signalling data also applies to such cases.
While
Unlike
In
In
As described above,
Although, for the sake of simplicity,
Unlike
Accordingly, in
Unlike
In
In
As described above,
Although, for the sake of simplicity,
Thus, given that the frame unit includes no PLPs using transmission methods transmitting only stream s1, the dynamic range of the signals received by the terminal may be constrained, which is likely to lead to improved received signal quality
Although
selecting one of transmitting data using a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, transmitting data using space-time block codes, and transmitting data using a MIMO system using a fixed precoding matrix;
selecting one of transmitting data using a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, and transmitting data using space-time block codes; and
selecting one of transmitting data using a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals and transmitting data using a MIMO system using a fixed precoding matrix.
While the above explanation is given for a frame unit having multiple PLPs, the following describes a frame unit having only one PLP.
Although
Furthermore, the first frame unit in
The second frame unit transmits symbol group 8102 of PLP#2-1. The transmission method is transmission using a single modulated signal.
The third frame unit transmits symbol group 8103 of PLP#3-1. The transmission method is a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals.
The fourth frame unit transmits symbol group 8104 of PLP#4-1. The transmission method is transmission using space-time block codes.
In
As such, the transmission method may be set by taking the data transmission speed and the data reception speed of the terminal into consideration for each PLP. This has the dual merits of allowing the data transmission speed to be enhanced and ensuring high data reception quality. The configuration method for the control information pertaining to the transmission method and so on for the P1 symbol and for the first and second signalling data may be as given by Tables 2 through 5, thus obtaining the same effects. The frame configuration of
The present Embodiment describes a method applicable to a system using a DVB standard and in which the transmission method involves performing a change of phase on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals. The transmission method involving performing a change of phase on precoded signals (or precoded signals having switched basebands) is described in the present description. Although the present Embodiment uses “control symbol” as a term of art, this term has no influence on the present invention.
The following describes the space-time block codes discussed in the present description and included in the present Embodiment.
The present Embodiment describes a reception method and a reception device applicable to a communication system using the DVB-T2 standard when the transmission method described in Embodiment E1, which involves performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, is used.
In
OFDM-related processors 8600_X and 8600_Y take the P1 symbol control information 8602 as input and modify the OFDM signal processing method (such as the Fourier transform) accordingly. (This is possible because, as described in Embodiment E1, the signals transmitted by the broadcaster include transmission method information in the P1 symbol.) The OFDM-related processors 8600_X and 8600_Y then output the baseband signals 704_X and 704_Y after performing demodulation thereon according to the signal processing method.
A P2 symbol demodulator 8603 (which may also apply to the signalling PLP) takes the baseband signals 704_X and 704_Y and the P1 symbol control information 8602 as input, performs signal processing and demodulation (including error-correcting decoding) in accordance with the P1 symbol control information, and outputs P2 symbol control information 8604.
A control information generator 8605 takes the P1 symbol control information 8602 and the P2 symbol control information 8604 as input, bundles the control information (pertaining to reception operations), and outputs a control signal 8606. Then, as shown in
A signal processor 711 takes signals 706_1, 706_2, 708_1, 708_2, 704_X, and 704_Y, as well as control signal 8606, as input, performs demodulation an decoding according to the information included in the control signal 8606, and outputs received data 712. The information included in the control signal pertains to the transmission method, modulation scheme, error-correcting coding method and coding rate thereof, error-correcting code block size, and so on used for each PLP.
When the transmission method used for the PLPs is one of spatial multiplexing MIMO, MIMO using a fixed precoding matrix, and a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, demodulation is performed by obtaining received (baseband) signals using the output of the channel estimators (705_1, 705_2, 707_1, and 707_2) and the relationship of the received (baseband) signals to the transmit signals. When the transmission method involves performing a change of phase on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals, demodulation is performed using the output of the channel estimators (705_1, 705_2, 707_1, and 707_2), the received (baseband) signals, and the relationship given by Math. 48 (formula 48).
The reception device from
In
OFDM-related processors 8600_X and 8600_Y take the P1 symbol control information 8602 as input and modify the OFDM signal processing method accordingly. (This is possible because, as described in Embodiment E1, the signals transmitted by the broadcaster include transmission method information in the P1 symbol.) The OFDM-related processors 8600_X and 8600_Y then output the baseband signals 704_X and 704_Y after performing demodulation thereon according to the signal processing method.
A first and second signalling data demodulator 8701 (which may also apply to the signalling PLP) takes the baseband signals 704_X and 704_Y and the P1 symbol control information 8602 as input, performs signal processing and demodulation (including error-correcting decoding) in accordance with the P1 symbol control information, and outputs first and second signalling data control information 8702.
A control information generator 8605 takes the P1 symbol control information 8602 and the first and second signalling data control information 8702 as input, bundles the control information (pertaining to reception operations), and outputs a control signal 8606. Then, as shown in
A signal processor 711 takes signals 706_1, 706_2, 708_1, 708_2, 704_X, and 704_Y, as well as control signal 8606, as input, performs demodulation an decoding according to the information included in the control signal 8606, and outputs received data 712. The information included in the control signal pertains to the transmission method, modulation scheme, error-correcting coding method and coding rate thereof, error-correcting code block size, and so on used for each PLP.
When the transmission method used for the PLPs is one of spatial multiplexing MIMO, MIMO using a fixed precoding matrix, and a transmission method performing a change of phase on precoded (or on precoded and switched) signals, demodulation is performed by obtaining received (baseband) signals using the output of the channel estimators (705_1, 705_2, 707_1, and 707_2) and the relationship of the received (baseband) signals to the transmit signals. When the transmission method involves performing a change of phase on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals, demodulation is performed using the output of the channel estimators (705_1, 705_2, 707_1, and 707_2), the received (baseband) signals, and the relationship given by Math. 48 (formula 48).
The P2 symbol or first and second signalling data demodulator 8801 takes the baseband signals 704_X and 704_Y, as well as the P1 symbol control information 8602, as input, uses the P1 symbol control information to determine whether the received signals conform to the DVB-T2 standard or to another standard (e.g., using Table in such a determination), performs signal processing and demodulation (including error-correcting decoding), and outputs control information 8802, which includes information indicating the standard to which the received signals conform. Otherwise, the operations are identical to those explained for
A reception device configured as described in the above Embodiment and receiving signals transmitted by a broadcaster having the transmission device described in Embodiment E1 provides higher received data quality by applying appropriate signal processing. In particular, when receiving signals transmitted using a transmission method that involves a change in phase applied to precoded (or precoded and switched) signals, data transmission effectiveness as well as signal quality are both improved in the LOS environment.
Although the present Embodiment is described as a reception device compatible with the transmission method described in Embodiment E1, and therefore having two antennas, no limitation is intended in this regard. The reception device may also have three or more antennas. In such cases, the data reception quality may be further improved by enhancing the diversity gain. Also, the transmission device of the broadcaster may have three or more transmit antennas and transmit three or more modulated signals. The same effects are achievable by accordingly increasing the number of antennas on the reception device of the terminal. Alternatively, the reception device may have only one antenna and apply maximum likelihood detection or approximate maximum likelihood detection. In such circumstances, the transmission method is preferably one that involves a change in phase of precoded (or precoded and switched) signals.
The transmission method need not be limited to the specific methods explained in the present description. As long as precoding occurs and is preceded or followed by a change in phase, the same results are obtainable for the present Embodiment.
The system of Embodiment E1, which applies, to the DVB-T2 standard, a transmission method involving a change in phase performed on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals, includes control information indicating the pilot insertion method in the L1 pre-signalling information. The present Embodiment describes a method of applying a transmission method that involves a change in phase performed on precoded signals (or precoded signals having switched basebands) when the pilot insertion method in the L1 pre-signalling information is changed.
The following describes a method of applying a transmission method involving a change in phase performed on precoded signals (or precoded signals having switched basebands) complementing the pilot insertion method. In this example, the transmission method involves preparing ten different phase changing values, namely F[0], F[1], F[2], F[3], F[4], F[5], F[6], F[7], F[8], and F[9].
Naturally, the insertion method (insertion interval) for the frequency-time frame configuration of
Accordingly, although the broadcaster transmits control information indicating the pilot pattern (pilot insertion method) in the L1 pre-signalling information, when the transmission method selected by the broadcaster method involves a change in phase performed on precoded signals (or precoded signals having switched basebands), the control information may additionally indicate the phase changing value allocation method used in the selected method through the control information given by Table 3 or Table 4. Thus, the reception device of the terminal receiving the modulated signals transmitted by the broadcaster is able to determine the phase changing value allocation method by obtaining the control information indicating the pilot pattern in the L1 pre-signalling data. (This presumes that the transmission method selected by the broadcaster for PLP transmission from Table 3 or Table 4 is one that involves a change in phase on precoded signals (or precoded signals having switched basebands)). Although the above description uses the example of L1 pre-signalling data, the above-described control information may also be included in the first and second signalling data when, as described for
The following describes further variant examples. Table 6 lists sample phase changing patterns and corresponding modulation schemes.
TABLE 6
No. of Modulated
Modulation
Phase Changing
Signals
Scheme
Pattern
2
#1: QPSK, #2: QPSK
#1: —, #2: A
2
#1: QPSK, #2: 16-QAM
#1: —, #2: B
2
#1: 16-QAM, #2: 16-QAM
#1: —, #2: C
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
For example, as shown in Table 6, when the modulation scheme is indicated and the phase changing values to be used in the transmission method involving a change in phase performed on precoded signals (or precoded signals having switched basebands) have been determined, the above-described principles apply. That is, transmitting only the control information pertaining to the pilot pattern, the PLP transmission method, and the modulation scheme suffices to enable the reception device of the terminal to estimate the phase changing value allocation method (in the time-frequency domain) by obtaining this control information. In Table 6, the Phase Changing Method column lists a dash to indicate that no change in phase is performed, and lists #A, #B, or #C to indicate phase changing methods #A, #B, and #C. Similarly, as shown in Table 1, when the modulation scheme and the error-correcting coding method are indicated and the phase changing values to be used in the transmission method involving a change in phase of precoded signals (or precoded signals having switched basebands) have been determined, then transmitting only the control information pertaining to the pilot pattern, the PLP transmission method, the modulation scheme, and the error-correcting codes in the P2 symbol suffices to enable the reception device of the terminal to estimate the phase changing value allocation method (in the time-frequency domain) by obtaining this control information.
However, unlike Table 1 and Table 6, two or more different types of transmission scheme involving a change in phase performed on precoded signals (or precoded signals having switched basebands) may be selected, despite the modulation scheme having been determined (For example, the transmission schemes may have a different period (cycle), or use different phase changing values). Alternatively, two or more different types of transmission scheme involving a change in phase performed on precoded signals (or precoded signals having switched basebands) may be selected, despite the modulation scheme and the error-correction scheme having been determined. Furthermore, two or more different types of transmission scheme involving a change in phase performed on precoded signals (or precoded signals having switched basebands) may be selected, despite the error-correction scheme having been determined. In such cases, as shown in Table 4, the transmission scheme involves switching between phase changing values. However, information pertaining to the allocation scheme of the phase changing values (in the time-frequency domain) may also be transmitted.
Table 7 lists control information configuration examples for information pertaining to such allocation methods.
TABLE 7
PHASE_FRAME_ARRANGEMENT
(2-bit)
Control Information
00
allocation scheme #1
01
allocation scheme #2
10
allocation scheme #3
11
allocation scheme #4
For example, suppose that the transmission device of the broadcaster selects
As described above, a phase changing value allocation method for the transmission method involving a change in phase performed on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals may be realized through the pilot insertion method. In addition, by reliably transmitting such allocation method information to the receiving party, the reception device derives the dual benefits of improved data transmission efficiency and enhanced received signal quality.
Although the present Embodiment describes a broadcaster using two transmit signals, the same applies to broadcasters using a transmission device having three or more transmit antennas transmitting three or more signals. The transmission method need not be limited to the specific methods explained in the present description. As long as precoding occurs and is preceded or followed by a change in phase, the same results are obtainable for the present Embodiment.
The pilot signal configuration method is not limited to the present Embodiment. When the transmission method involves performing a change of phase on precoded (or precoded and switched) signals, the reception device need only implement the relationship given by Math. 48 (formula 48) (e.g., the reception device may know the pilot pattern signals transmitted by the transmission device in advance). This applies to all Embodiments discussed in the present description.
The transmission devices pertaining to the present invention, as illustrated by
The schemes for regularly performing phase change on the modulated signal after precoding described in Embodiments 1 through 4, Embodiment A1, Embodiments C1 through C7, Embodiments D1 through D3 and Embodiments E1 through E3 are applicable to any baseband signals s1 and s2 mapped in the I-Q plane. Therefore, in Embodiments 1 through 4, Embodiment A1, Embodiments C1 through C7, Embodiments D1 through D3 and Embodiments E1 through E3, the baseband signals s1 and s2 have not been described in detail. On the other hand, when the scheme for regularly performing phase change on the modulated signal after precoding is applied to the baseband signals s1 and s2 generated from the error correction coded data, excellent reception quality can be achieved by controlling average power (average value) of the baseband signals s1 and s2. In the present embodiment, the following describes a scheme of setting the average power of s1 and s2 when the scheme for regularly performing phase change on the modulated signal after precoding is applied to the baseband signals s1 and s2 generated from the error correction coded data.
As an example, the modulation schemes for the baseband signal s1 and the baseband signal s2 are described as QPSK and 16QAM, respectively.
Since the modulation scheme for s1 is QPSK, s1 transmits two bits per symbol. Let the two bits to be transmitted be referred to as b0 and b1. On the other hand, since the modulation scheme for s2 is 16QAM, s2 transmits four bits per symbol. Let the four bits to be transmitted be referred to as b2, b3, b4 and b5. The transmission device transmits one slot composed of one symbol for s1 and one symbol for s2, i.e. six bits b0, b1, b2, b3, b4 and b5 per slot.
For example, in
Also, in
Here, assume that the average power of s1 is equal to the average power of s2, i.e. h shown in
[Math. 80]
√{square root over (2z)} (formula 80)
On the other hand, when h is represented by formula 78 in
This is the reason.
If the reception device performs error correction decoding (e.g. belief propagation decoding such as a sum-product decoding in a case where the communication system uses LDPC codes) under this situation, due to a difference in reliability that “the absolute values of the log-likelihood ratio for b0 and b1 are higher than the absolute values of the log-likelihood ratio for b2 through b5”, a problem that the data reception quality degrades in the reception device by being affected by the absolute values of the log-likelihood ratio for b2 through b5 arises.
In order to overcome the problem, the difference between the absolute values of the log-likelihood ratio for b0 and b1 and the absolute values of the log-likelihood ratio for b2 through b5 should be reduced compared with
Therefore, it is considered that the average power (average value) of s1 is made to be different from the average power (average value) of s2.
The following explains some examples of operations of the power changer.
First, an example of the operation is described using
The power changer (9901B) receives a (mapped) baseband signal 307B for the modulation scheme 16QAM and a control signal (9900) as input. Letting a value for power change set based on the control signal (9900) be u, the power changer outputs a signal (9902B) obtained by multiplying the (mapped) baseband signal 307B for the modulation scheme 16QAM by u. Let u be a real number, and u>1.0. Letting the precoding matrix used in the scheme for regularly performing phase change on the modulated signal after precoding be F and the phase changing value used for regularly performing phase change be y(t) (y(t) may be imaginary number having the absolute value of 1, i.e. ejθ(t), the following formula is satisfied.
Therefore, a ratio of the average power for QPSK to the average power for 16QAM is set to 1:u2. With this structure, the reception device is in a reception condition in which the absolute value of the log-likelihood ratio shown in
The following describes a case where u in the ratio of the average power for QPSK to the average power for 16QAM 1:u2 is set as shown in the following formula.
[Math. 83]
u=√{square root over (5)} (formula 83)
In this case, the minimum Euclidian distance between signal points in the I-Q plane for QPSK and the minimum Euclidian distance between signal points in the I-Q plane for 16QAM can be the same. Therefore, excellent reception quality can be achieved.
The condition that the minimum Euclidian distances between signal points in the I-Q plane for two different modulation schemes are equalized, however, is a mere example of the scheme of setting the ratio of the average power for QPSK to the average power for 16QAM. For example, according to other conditions such as a code length and a coding rate of an error correction code used for error correction codes, excellent reception quality may be achieved when the value u for power change is set to a value (higher value or lower value) different from the value at which the minimum Euclidian distances between signal points in the I-Q plane for two different modulation schemes are equalized. Considering the processing efficiency, a scheme of setting the value u as shown in the following formula is considered, for example.
[Math. 84]
u=√{square root over (2)} (formula 84)
This will be described later in detail.
In the conventional technology, transmission power control is generally performed based on feedback information from a communication partner. The present invention is characterized in that the transmission power is controlled regardless of the feedback information from the communication partner in the present embodiment. Detailed description is made on this point.
The above describes that the value u for power change is set based on the control signal (9900). The following describes setting of the value u for power change based on the control signal (9900) in order to improve data reception quality in the reception device in detail.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a block length (the number of bits constituting one coded block, and is also referred to as the code length) for the error correction coding used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of block lengths for the error correction codes.
Examples of the error correction codes include block codes such as Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, LDPC codes, or the like. In many communication systems and broadcasting systems, a plurality of block lengths are supported. Encoded data for which error correction codes whose block length is selected from among the plurality of supported block lengths has been performed is distributed to two systems. The encoded data having been distributed to the two systems is modulated in the modulation scheme for s1 and in the modulation scheme for s2 to generate the (mapped) baseband signals s1(t) and s2(t).
The control signal (9900) is a signal indicating the selected block length for the error correction codes described above. The power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the control signal (9900).
The present invention is characterized in that the power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the selected block length indicated by the control signal (9900). Here, a value for power change set according to a block length X is referred to as uLX
For example, when 1000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL1000. When 1500 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL1500. When 3000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL3000. In this case, for example, by setting uL1000, uL1500 and uL3000 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each code length. Depending on the set code length, however, the effect might not be obtained even if the value for power change is changed. In such a case, even when the code length is changed, it is unnecessary to change the value for power change (for example, uL1000=uL1500 may be satisfied. What is important is that two or more values exist in uL1000, uL1500 and uL3000).
Although the case of three code lengths is taken as an example in the above description, the present invention is not limited to this. The important point is that two or more values for power change exist when there are two or more code lengths that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values for power change when the code length is set, and performs power change.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a coding rate for the error correction codes used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of coding rates for the error correction codes.
Examples of the error correction codes include block codes such as Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, LDPC codes, or the like. In many communication systems and broadcasting systems, a plurality of coding rates are supported. Encoded data for which error correction codes whose coding rate is selected from among the plurality of supported coding rates has been performed is distributed to two systems. The encoded data having been distributed to the two systems is modulated in the modulation scheme for s1 and in the modulation scheme for s2 to generate the (mapped) baseband signals s1(t) and s2(t).
The control signal (9900) is a signal indicating the selected coding rate for the error correction codes described above. The power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the control signal (9900).
The present invention is characterized in that the power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the selected coding rate indicated by the control signal (9900). Here, a value for power change set according to a coding rate rx is referred to as urX.
For example, when r1 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur1. When r2 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur2. When r3 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur3. In this case, for example, by setting ur1, ur2 and ur3 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each coding rate. Depending on the set coding rate, however, the effect might not be obtained even if the value for power change is changed. In such a case, even when the coding rate is changed, it is unnecessary to change the value for power change (for example, ur1=ur2 may be satisfied. What is important is that two or more values exist in ur1, ur2 and ur3).
Note that, as examples of r1, r2 and r3 described above, coding rates ½, ⅔ and ¾ are considered when the error correction code is the LDPC code.
Although the case of three coding rates is taken as an example in the above description, the present invention is not limited to this. The important point is that two or more values for power change exist when there are two or more coding rates that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values for power change when the coding rate is set, and performs power change.
In order for the reception device to achieve excellent data reception quality, it is important to implement the following.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a modulation scheme used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of modulation schemes.
Here, as an example, a case where the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to QPSK and the modulation scheme for s2 is changed from 16QAM to 64QAM by the control signal (or can be set to either 16QAM or 64QAM) is considered. Note that, in a case where the modulation scheme for s2(t) is 64QAM, the mapping scheme for s2(t) is as shown in
By performing mapping in this way, the average power obtained when h in
That is to say, in
In
Note that, in the above description, the “modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to QPSK”. It is also considered that the modulation scheme for s2 is fixed to QPSK. In this case, power change is assumed to be not performed for the fixed modulation scheme (here, QPSK), and to be performed for a plurality of modulation schemes that can be set (here, 16QAM and 64QAM). That is to say, in this case, the transmission device does not have the structure shown in
When the modulation scheme for s2 is fixed to QPSK and the modulation scheme for s1 is changed from 16QAM to 64QAM (is set to either 16QAM or 64QAM), the relationship u16<u64 should be satisfied (note that a multiplied value for power change in 16QAM is u16, a multiplied value for power change in 64QAM is u64, and power change is not performed in QPSK).
Also, when a set of the modulation scheme for s1 and the modulation scheme for s2 can be set to any one of a set of QPSK and 16QAM, a set of 16QAM and QPSK, a set of QPSK and 64QAM and a set of 64QAM and QPSK, the relationship u16<u64 should be satisfied.
The following describes a case where the above-mentioned description is generalized.
Let the modulation scheme for s1 be fixed to a modulation scheme C in which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is c. Also, let the modulation scheme for s2 be set to either a modulation scheme A in which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is a or a modulation scheme B in which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is b (a>b>c) (however, let the average power (average value) for s2 in the modulation scheme A be equal to the average power (average value) for s2 in the modulation scheme B).
In this case, a value for power change set when the modulation scheme A is set to the modulation scheme for s2 is ua. Also, a value for power change set when the modulation scheme B is set to the modulation scheme for s2 is ub. In this case, when the relationship ub<ua is satisfied, excellent data reception quality is obtained in the reception device.
Power change is assumed to be not performed for the fixed modulation scheme (here, modulation scheme C), and to be performed for a plurality of modulation schemes that can be set (here, modulation schemes A and B). When the modulation scheme for s2 is fixed to the modulation scheme C and the modulation scheme for s1 is changed from the modulation scheme A to the modulation scheme B (is set to either the modulation schemes A or B), the relationship ub<ua should be satisfied. Also, when a set of the modulation scheme for s1 and the modulation scheme for s2 can be set to any one of a set of the modulation scheme C and the modulation scheme A, a set of the modulation scheme A and the modulation scheme C, a set of the modulation scheme C and the modulation scheme B and a set of the modulation scheme B and the modulation scheme C, the relationship ub<ua should be satisfied.
The following describes an example of the operation different from that described in Example 1, using
The power changer (9901B) receives a (mapped) baseband signal 307B for the modulation scheme 16QAM and a control signal (9900) as input. Letting a value for power change set based on the control signal (9900) be u, the power changer outputs a signal (9902B) obtained by multiplying the (mapped) baseband signal 307B for the modulation scheme 16QAM by u. Let u be a real number, and u<1.0. Letting the precoding matrix used in the scheme for regularly performing phase change on the modulated signal after precoding be F and the phase changing value used for regularly performing phase change be y(t) (y(t) may be imaginary number having the absolute value of 1, i.e. ejθ(t), the following formula is satisfied.
Therefore, a ratio of the average power for 64QAM to the average power for 16QAM is set to 1:u2. With this structure, the reception device is in a reception condition as shown in
In the conventional technology, transmission power control is generally performed based on feedback information from a communication partner. The present invention is characterized in that the transmission power is controlled regardless of the feedback information from the communication partner in the present embodiment. Detailed description is made on this point.
The above describes that the value u for power change is set based on the control signal (9900). The following describes setting of the value u for power change based on the control signal (9900) in order to improve data reception quality in the reception device in detail.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a block length (the number of bits constituting one coded block, and is also referred to as the code length) for the error correction codes used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of block lengths for the error correction codes.
Examples of the error correction codes include block codes such as Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, LDPC codes, or the like. In many communication systems and broadcasting systems, a plurality of block lengths are supported. Encoded data for which error correction codes whose block length is selected from among the plurality of supported block lengths has been performed is distributed to two systems. The encoded data having been distributed to the two systems is modulated in the modulation scheme for s1 and in the modulation scheme for s2 to generate the (mapped) baseband signals s1(t) and s2(t).
The control signal (9900) is a signal indicating the selected block length for the error correction codes described above. The power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the control signal (9900).
The present invention is characterized in that the power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the selected block length indicated by the control signal (9900). Here, a value for power change set according to a block length X is referred to as uLX
For example, when 1000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL1000. When 1500 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL1500. When 3000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL3000. In this case, for example, by setting uL1000, uL1500 and uL3000 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each code length. Depending on the set code length, however, the effect might not be obtained even if the value for power change is changed. In such a case, even when the code length is changed, it is unnecessary to change the value for power change (for example, uL1000=uL1500 may be satisfied. What is important is that two or more values exist in uL1000, uL1500 and uL3000).
Although the case of three code lengths is taken as an example in the above description, the present invention is not limited to this. The important point is that two or more values for power change exist when there are two or more code lengths that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values for power change when the code length is set, and performs power change.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a coding rate for the error correction codes used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of coding rates for the error correction codes.
Examples of the error correction codes include block codes such as Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, LDPC codes, or the like. In many communication systems and broadcasting systems, a plurality of coding rates are supported. Encoded data for which error correction codes whose coding rate is selected from among the plurality of supported coding rates has been performed is distributed to two systems. The encoded data having been distributed to the two systems is modulated in the modulation scheme for s1 and in the modulation scheme for s2 to generate the (mapped) baseband signals s1(t) and s2(t).
The control signal (9900) is a signal indicating the selected coding rate for the error correction codes described above. The power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the control signal (9900).
The present invention is characterized in that the power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the selected coding rate indicated by the control signal (9900). Here, a value for power change set according to a coding rate rx is referred to as urx.
For example, when r1 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur1. When r2 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur2. When r3 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur3. In this case, for example, by setting ur1, ur2 and ur3 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each coding rate. Depending on the set coding rate, however, the effect might not be obtained even if the value for power change is changed. In such a case, even when the coding rate is changed, it is unnecessary to change the value for power change (for example, ur1=ur2 may be satisfied. What is important is that two or more values exist in ur1, ur2 and ur3). Note that, as examples of r1, r2 and r3 described above, coding rates ½, ⅔ and ¾ are considered when the error correction code is the LDPC code.
Although the case of three coding rates is taken as an example in the above description, the present invention is not limited to this. The important point is that two or more values for power change exist when there are two or more coding rates that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values for power change when the coding rate is set, and performs power change.
In order for the reception device to achieve excellent data reception quality, it is important to implement the following.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a modulation scheme used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of modulation schemes.
Here, as an example, a case where the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to 64QAM and the modulation scheme for s2 is changed from 16QAM to QPSK by the control signal (or can be set to either 16QAM or QPSK) is considered. In a case where the modulation scheme for s1 is 64QAM, the mapping scheme for s1(t) is as shown in
By performing mapping in this way, the average power in 16QAM becomes equal to the average power (average value) in QPSK.
In
Note that, in the above description, the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to 64QAM. When the modulation scheme for s2 is fixed to 64QAM and the modulation scheme for s1 is changed from 16QAM to QPSK (is set to either 16QAM or QPSK), the relationship u4<u16 should be satisfied (the same considerations should be made as the example 1-3) (note that a multiplied value for power change in 16QAM is u16, a multiplied value for power change in QPSK is u4, and power change is not performed in 64QAM). Also, when a set of the modulation scheme for s1 and the modulation scheme for s2 can be set to any one of a set of 64QAM and 16QAM, a set of 16QAM and 64QAM, a set of 64QAM and QPSK and a set of QPSK and 64QAM, the relationship u4<u16 should be satisfied.
The following describes a case where the above-mentioned description is generalized.
Let the modulation scheme for s1 be fixed to a modulation scheme C in which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is c. Also, let the modulation scheme for s2 be set to either a modulation scheme A in which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is a or a modulation scheme B in which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is b (c>b>a) (however, let the average power (average value) for s2 in the modulation scheme A be equal to the average power (average value) for s2 in the modulation scheme B).
In this case, a value for power change set when the modulation scheme A is set to the modulation scheme for s2 is ua. Also, a value for power change set when the modulation scheme B is set to the modulation scheme for s2 is ub. In this case, when the relationship ua<ub is satisfied, excellent data reception quality is obtained in the reception device.
Power change is assumed to be not performed for the fixed modulation scheme (here, modulation scheme C), and to be performed for a plurality of modulation schemes that can be set (here, modulation schemes A and B). When the modulation scheme for s2 is fixed to the modulation scheme C and the modulation scheme for s1 is changed from the modulation scheme A to the modulation scheme B (is set to either the modulation schemes A or B), the relationship ua<ub should be satisfied. Also, when a set of the modulation scheme for s1 and the modulation scheme for s2 can be set to any one of a set of the modulation scheme C and the modulation scheme A, a set of the modulation scheme A and the modulation scheme C, a set of the modulation scheme C and the modulation scheme B and a set of the modulation scheme B and the modulation scheme C, the relationship ua<ub should be satisfied.
The following describes an example of the operation different from that described in Example 1, using
The power changer (9901B) receives a (mapped) baseband signal 307B for the modulation scheme 64QAM and a control signal (9900) as input. Letting a value for power change set based on the control signal (9900) be u, the power changer outputs a signal (9902B) obtained by multiplying the (mapped) baseband signal 307B for the modulation scheme 64QAM by u. Let u be a real number, and u>1.0. Letting the precoding matrix used in the scheme for regularly performing phase change on the modulated signal after precoding be F and the phase changing value used for regularly performing phase change be y(t) (y(t) may be imaginary number having the absolute value of 1, i.e. ejθ(t), the following formula is satisfied.
Therefore, a ratio of the average power for 16QAM to the average power for 64QAM is set to 1:u2. With this structure, the reception device is in a reception condition as shown in
In the conventional technology, transmission power control is generally performed based on feedback information from a communication partner. The present invention is characterized in that the transmission power is controlled regardless of the feedback information from the communication partner in the present embodiment. Detailed description is made on this point.
The above describes that the value u for power change is set based on the control signal (9900). The following describes setting of the value u for power change based on the control signal (9900) in order to improve data reception quality in the reception device in detail.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a block length (the number of bits constituting one coded block, and is also referred to as the code length) for the error correction codes used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of block lengths for the error correction codes.
Examples of the error correction codes include block codes such as Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, LDPC codes, or the like. In many communication systems and broadcasting systems, a plurality of block lengths are supported. Encoded data for which error correction codes whose block length is selected from among the plurality of supported block lengths has been performed is distributed to two systems. The encoded data having been distributed to the two systems is modulated in the modulation scheme for s1 and in the modulation scheme for s2 to generate the (mapped) baseband signals s1(t) and s2(t).
The control signal (9900) is a signal indicating the selected block length for the error correction codes described above. The power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the control signal (9900).
The present invention is characterized in that the power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the selected block length indicated by the control signal (9900). Here, a value for power change set according to a block length X is referred to as uLX
For example, when 1000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL1000. When 1500 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL1500. When 3000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL3000. In this case, for example, by setting uL1000, uL1500 and uL3000 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each code length. Depending on the set code length, however, the effect might not be obtained even if the value for power change is changed. In such a case, even when the code length is changed, it is unnecessary to change the value for power change (for example, uL1000=uL1500 may be satisfied. What is important is that two or more values exist in uL1000, uL1500 and uL3000).
Although the case of three code lengths is taken as an example in the above description, the present invention is not limited to this. The important point is that two or more values for power change exist when there are two or more code lengths that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values for power change when the code length is set, and performs power change.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a coding rate for the error correction codes used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of coding rates for the error correction codes.
Examples of the error correction codes include block codes such as Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, LDPC codes, or the like. In many communication systems and broadcasting systems, a plurality of coding rates are supported. Encoded data for which error correction codes whose coding rate is selected from among the plurality of supported coding rates has been performed is distributed to two systems. The encoded data having been distributed to the two systems is modulated in the modulation scheme for s1 and in the modulation scheme for s2 to generate the (mapped) baseband signals s1(t) and s2(t).
The control signal (9900) is a signal indicating the selected coding rate for the error correction codes described above. The power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the control signal (9900).
The present invention is characterized in that the power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the selected coding rate indicated by the control signal (9900). Here, a value for power change set according to a coding rate rx is referred to as urx.
For example, when r1 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur1. When r2 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur2. When r3 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur3. In this case, for example, by setting ur1, ur2 and ur3 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each coding rate. Depending on the set coding rate, however, the effect might not be obtained even if the value for power change is changed. In such a case, even when the coding rate is changed, it is unnecessary to change the value for power change (for example, ur1=ur2 may be satisfied. What is important is that two or more values exist in ur1, ur2 and ur3).
Note that, as examples of r1, r2 and r3 described above, coding rates ½, ⅔ and ¾ are considered when the error correction code is the LDPC code.
Although the case of three coding rates is taken as an example in the above description, the present invention is not limited to this. The important point is that two or more values for power change exist when there are two or more coding rates that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values for power change when the coding rate is set, and performs power change.
In order for the reception device to achieve excellent data reception quality, it is important to implement the following.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a modulation scheme used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of modulation schemes.
Here, as an example, a case where the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to 16QAM and the modulation scheme for s2 is changed from 64QAM to QPSK by the control signal (or can be set to either 64QAM or QPSK) is considered. In a case where the modulation scheme for s1 is 16QAM, the mapping scheme for s2(t) is as shown in
By performing mapping in this way, the average power in 16QAM becomes equal to the average power in QPSK.
In
Note that, in the above description, the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to 16QAM. When the modulation scheme for s2 is fixed to 16QAM and the modulation scheme for s1 is changed from 64QAM to QPSK (is set to either 64QAM or QPSK), the relationship u4<u64 should be satisfied (the same considerations should be made as the example 1-3) (note that a multiplied value for power change in 64QAM is u64, a multiplied value for power change in QPSK is u4, and power change is not performed in 16QAM). Also, when a set of the modulation scheme for s1 and the modulation scheme for s2 can be set to any one of a set of 16QAM and 64QAM, a set of 64QAM and 16QAM, a set of 16QAM and QPSK and a set of QPSK and 16QAM, the relationship u4<u64 should be satisfied.
The following describes a case where the above-mentioned description is generalized.
Let the modulation scheme for s1 be fixed to a modulation scheme C in which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is c. Also, let the modulation scheme for s2 be set to either a modulation scheme A in which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is a or a modulation scheme B in which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is b (c>b>a) (however, let the average power (average value) for s2 in the modulation scheme A be equal to the average power (average value) for s2 in the modulation scheme B).
In this case, a value for power change set when the modulation scheme A is set to the modulation scheme for s2 is ua. Also, a value for power change set when the modulation scheme B is set to the modulation scheme for s2 is ub. In this case, when the relationship ua<ub is satisfied, excellent data reception quality is obtained in the reception device.
Power change is assumed to be not performed for the fixed modulation scheme (here, modulation scheme C), and to be performed for a plurality of modulation schemes that can be set (here, modulation schemes A and B). When the modulation scheme for s2 is fixed to the modulation scheme C and the modulation scheme for s1 is changed from the modulation scheme A to the modulation scheme B (is set to either the modulation schemes A or B), the relationship ua<ub should be satisfied. Also, when a set of the modulation scheme for s1 and the modulation scheme for s2 can be set to any one of a set of the modulation scheme C and the modulation scheme A, a set of the modulation scheme A and the modulation scheme C, a set of the modulation scheme C and the modulation scheme B and a set of the modulation scheme B and the modulation scheme C, the relationship ua<ub should be satisfied.
The case where power change is performed for one of the modulation schemes for s1 and s2 has been described above. The following describes a case where power change is performed for both of the modulation schemes for s1 and s2.
An example of the operation is described using
The power changer (9901A) receives a (mapped) baseband signal 307A for the modulation scheme QPSK and the control signal (9900) as input. Letting a value for power change set based on the control signal (9900) be v, the power changer outputs a signal (9902A) obtained by multiplying the (mapped) baseband signal 307A for the modulation scheme QPSK by v.
The power changer (9901B) receives a (mapped) baseband signal 307B for the modulation scheme 16QAM and a control signal (9900) as input. Letting a value for power change set based on the control signal (9900) be u, the power changer outputs a signal (9902B) obtained by multiplying the (mapped) baseband signal 307B for the modulation scheme 16QAM by u. Then, let u=v×w (w>1.0).
Letting the precoding matrix used in the scheme for regularly performing phase change be F[t], formula 87 shown next is satisfied.
Letting the precoding matrix used in the scheme for regularly performing phase change on the modulated signal after precoding be F and the phase changing value used for regularly performing phase change be y(t) (y(t) may be imaginary number having the absolute value of 1, i.e. ejθ(t), formula 87 shown next is satisfied.
Therefore, a ratio of the average power for QPSK to the average power for 16QAM is set to v2:u2=v2:v2×w2=1:w2. With this structure, the reception device is in a reception condition as shown in
In the conventional technology, transmission power control is generally performed based on feedback information from a communication partner. The present invention is characterized in that the transmission power is controlled regardless of the feedback information from the communication partner in the present embodiment. Detailed description is made on this point.
The above describes that the values v and u for power change are set based on the control signal (9900). The following describes setting of the values v and u for power change based on the control signal (9900) in order to improve data reception quality in the reception device in detail.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a block length (the number of bits constituting one coded block, and is also referred to as the code length) for the error correction codes used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of block lengths for the error correction codes.
Examples of the error correction codes include block codes such as Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, LDPC codes, or the like. In many communication systems and broadcasting systems, a plurality of block lengths are supported. Encoded data for which error correction codes whose block length is selected from among the plurality of supported block lengths has been performed is distributed to two systems. The encoded data having been distributed to the two systems is modulated in the modulation scheme for s1 and in the modulation scheme for s2 to generate the (mapped) baseband signals s1(t) and s2(t).
The control signal (9900) is a signal indicating the selected block length for the error correction codes described above. The power changer (9901B) sets the value v for power change according to the control signal (9900). Similarly, the power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the control signal (9900).
The present invention is characterized in that the power changers (9901A and 9901B) respectively set the values v and u for power change according to the selected block length indicated by the control signal (9900). Here, values for power change set according to the block length X are referred to as vLX and uLX.
For example, when 1000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vL1000. When 1500 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vL1500. When 3000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vL3000.
On the other hand, when 1000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL1000. When 1500 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL1500. When 3000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL3000.
In this case, for example, by setting vL1000, vL1500 and vL3000 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each code length. Similarly, by setting uL1000, uL1500 and uL3000 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each code length. Depending on the set code length, however, the effect might not be obtained even if the value for power change is changed. In such a case, even when the code length is changed, it is unnecessary to change the value for power change (for example, uL1000=uL1500 may be satisfied, and vL1000=vL1500 may be satisfied. What is important is that two or more values exist in a set of vL1000, vL1500 and vL3000, and that two or more values exist in a set of uL1000, uL1500 and uL3000). Note that, as described above, vLX and uLX are set so as to satisfy the ratio of the average power 1:w2.
Although the case of three code lengths is taken as an example in the above description, the present invention is not limited to this. One important point is that two or more values uLX for power change exist when there are two or more code lengths that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values uLX for power change when the code length is set, and performs power change. Another important point is that two or more values vLX for power change exist when there are two or more code lengths that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values vLX for power change when the code length is set, and performs power change.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a coding rate for the error correction codes used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of coding rates for the error correction codes.
Examples of the error correction codes include block codes such as Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, LDPC codes, or the like. In many communication systems and broadcasting systems, a plurality of coding rates are supported. Encoded data for which error correction codes whose coding rate is selected from among the plurality of supported coding rates has been performed is distributed to two systems. The encoded data having been distributed to the two systems is modulated in the modulation scheme for s1 and in the modulation scheme for s2 to generate the (mapped) baseband signals s1(t) and s2(t).
The control signal (9900) is a signal indicating the selected coding rate for the error correction codes described above. The power changer (9901A) sets the value v for power change according to the control signal (9900). Similarly, the power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the control signal (9900).
The present invention is characterized in that the power changers (9901A and 9901B) respectively set the values v and u for power change according to the selected coding rate indicated by the control signal (9900). Here, values for power change set according to the coding rate rx are referred to as vrx and urx.
For example, when r1 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vr1. When r2 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vr2. When r3 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vr3.
Also, when r1 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur1. When r2 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur2. When r3 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur3.
In this case, for example, by setting vr1, vr2 and vr3 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each code length. Similarly, by setting ur1, ur2 and ur3 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each coding rate. Depending on the set coding rate, however, the effect might not be obtained even if the value for power change is changed. In such a case, even when the coding rate is changed, it is unnecessary to change the value for power change (for example, vr1=vr2 may be satisfied, and ur1=ur2 may be satisfied. What is important is that two or more values exist in a set of vr1, vr2 and vr3, and that two or more values exist in a set of ur1, ur2 and ur3). Note that, as described above, vrX and urX are set so as to satisfy the ratio of the average power 1:w2.
Also, note that, as examples of r1, r2 and r3 described above, coding rates ½, ⅔ and ¾ are considered when the error correction code is the LDPC code.
Although the case of three coding rates is taken as an example in the above description, the present invention is not limited to this. One important point is that two or more values urx for power change exist when there are two or more coding rates that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values urx for power change when the coding rate is set, and performs power change. Another important point is that two or more values vrX for power change exist when there are two or more coding rates that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values vrX for power change when the coding rate is set, and performs power change.
In order for the reception device to achieve excellent data reception quality, it is important to implement the following.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a modulation scheme used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of modulation schemes.
Here, as an example, a case where the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to QPSK and the modulation scheme for s2 is changed from 16QAM to 64QAM by the control signal (or can be set to either 16QAM or 64QAM) is considered. In a case where the modulation scheme for s1 is QPSK, the mapping scheme for s1(t) is as shown in
In
In
Note that although “the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to QPSK” in the description above, it is possible that “the modulation scheme for s2 is fixed to QPSK”. In this case, power change is assumed to be not performed for the fixed modulation scheme (here, QPSK), and to be performed for a plurality of modulation schemes that can be set (here, 16QAM and 64QAM). When the fixed modulation scheme (here, QPSK) is set to s2, the following formula 88 is satisfied.
Given that, even when “the modulation scheme for s2 is fixed to QPSK and the modulation scheme for s1 is changed from 16QAM to 64QAM (set to either 16QAM or 64QAM)”, 1.0<w16<w64 should be fulfilled. (Note that the value used for the multiplication for the power change in the case of 16QAM is u=α×w16, the value used for the multiplication for the power change in the case of 64QAM is u=β×w64, the value used for the power change in the case of QPSK is v=α when the selectable modulation scheme is 16QAM and v=β when the selectable modulation scheme is 64QAM.) Also, when the set of (the modulation scheme for s1, the modulation scheme for s2) is selectable from the sets of (QPSK, 16QAM), (16QAM, QPSK), (QPSK, 64QAM) and (64QAM, QPSK), 1.0<w16<w64 should be fulfilled.
The following describes a case where the above-mentioned description is generalized.
For generalization, assume that the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to a modulation scheme C with which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is c. Also assume that the modulation scheme for s2 is selectable from a modulation scheme A with which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is a and a modulation scheme B with which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is b (a>b>c). In this case, when the modulation scheme for s2 is set to the modulation scheme A, assume that ratio between the average power of the modulation scheme for s1, which is the modulation scheme C, and the average power of the modulation scheme for s2, which is the modulation scheme A, is 1:wa2. Also, when the modulation scheme for s2 is set to the modulation scheme B, assume that ratio between the average power of the modulation scheme for s1, which is the modulation scheme C, and the average power of the modulation scheme for s2, which is the modulation scheme B, is 1:wb2. If this is the case, the reception device achieves a high data reception quality when wb<wa is fulfilled.
Note that although “the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to C” in the description above, even when “the modulation scheme for s2 is fixed to the modulation scheme C and the modulation scheme for s1 is changed from the modulation scheme A to the modulation scheme B (set to either the modulation scheme A or the modulation scheme B), the average powers should fulfill wb<wa. (If this is the case, as with the description above, when the average power of the modulation scheme C is 1, the average power of the modulation scheme A is wa2, and the average power of the modulation scheme B is wb2.) Also, when the set of (the modulation scheme for s1, the modulation scheme for s2) is selectable from the sets of (the modulation scheme C, the modulation scheme A), (the modulation scheme A, the modulation scheme C), (the modulation scheme C, the modulation scheme B) and (the modulation scheme B, the modulation scheme C), the average powers should fulfill wb<wa.
The following describes an example of the operation different from that described in Example 4, using
The power changer (9901A) receives a (mapped) baseband signal 307A for the modulation scheme 64QAM and the control signal (9900) as input. Letting a value for power change set based on the control signal (9900) be v, the power changer outputs a signal (9902A) obtained by multiplying the (mapped) baseband signal 307A for the modulation scheme 64QAM by v.
The power changer (9901B) receives a (mapped) baseband signal 307B for the modulation scheme 16QAM and a control signal (9900) as input. Letting a value for power change set based on the control signal (9900) be u, the power changer outputs a signal (9902B) obtained by multiplying the (mapped) baseband signal 307B for the modulation scheme 16QAM by u. Then, let u=v×w (w<1.0).
Letting the precoding matrix used in the scheme for regularly performing phase change on the modulated signal after precoding be F and the phase changing value used for regularly performing phase change be y(t) (y(t) may be imaginary number having the absolute value of 1, i.e. ejθ(t), formula 87 shown above is satisfied.
Therefore, a ratio of the average power for 64QAM to the average power for 16QAM is set to v2:u2=v2:v2×w2=1:w2. With this structure, the reception device is in a reception condition as shown in
In the conventional technology, transmission power control is generally performed based on feedback information from a communication partner. The present invention is characterized in that the transmission power is controlled regardless of the feedback information from the communication partner in the present embodiment. Detailed description is made on this point.
The above describes that the values v and u for power change are set based on the control signal (9900). The following describes setting of the values v and u for power change based on the control signal (9900) in order to improve data reception quality in the reception device in detail.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a block length (the number of bits constituting one coded block, and is also referred to as the code length) for the error correction codes used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of block lengths for the error correction codes.
Examples of the error correction codes include block codes such as Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, LDPC codes, or the like. In many communication systems and broadcasting systems, a plurality of block lengths are supported. Encoded data for which error correction codes whose block length is selected from among the plurality of supported block lengths has been performed is distributed to two systems. The encoded data having been distributed to the two systems is modulated in the modulation scheme for s1 and in the modulation scheme for s2 to generate the (mapped) baseband signals s1(t) and s2(t).
The control signal (9900) is a signal indicating the selected block length for the error correction codes described above. The power changer (9901B) sets the value v for power change according to the control signal (9900). Similarly, the power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the control signal (9900).
The present invention is characterized in that the power changers (9901A and 9901B) respectively set the values v and u for power change according to the selected block length indicated by the control signal (9900). Here, values for power change set according to the block length X are referred to as vLX and uLX.
For example, when 1000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vL1000. When 1500 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vL1500. When 3000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vL3000.
On the other hand, when 1000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL1000. When 1500 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL1500. When 3000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL3000.
In this case, for example, by setting vL1000, vL1500 and vL3000 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each code length. Similarly, by setting uL1000, uL1500 and uL3000 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each code length. Depending on the set code length, however, the effect might not be obtained even if the value for power change is changed. In such a case, even when the code length is changed, it is unnecessary to change the value for power change (for example, uL1000=uL1500 may be satisfied, and vL1000=vL1500 may be satisfied. What is important is that two or more values exist in a set of vL1000, vL1500 and vL3000, and that two or more values exist in a set of uL1000, uL1500 and uL3000). Note that, as described above, vLX and uLX are set so as to satisfy the ratio of the average power 1:w2.
Although the case of three code lengths is taken as an example in the above description, the present invention is not limited to this. One important point is that two or more values uLX for power change exist when there are two or more code lengths that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values uLX for power change when the code length is set, and performs power change. Another important point is that two or more values vLX for power change exist when there are two or more code lengths that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values vLX for power change when the code length is set, and performs power change.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a coding rate for the error correction codes used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of coding rates for the error correction codes.
Examples of the error correction codes include block codes such as Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, LDPC codes, or the like. In many communication systems and broadcasting systems, a plurality of coding rates are supported. Encoded data for which error correction codes whose coding rate is selected from among the plurality of supported coding rates has been performed is distributed to two systems. The encoded data having been distributed to the two systems is modulated in the modulation scheme for s1 and in the modulation scheme for s2 to generate the (mapped) baseband signals s1(t) and s2(t).
The control signal (9900) is a signal indicating the selected coding rate for the error correction codes described above. The power changer (9901A) sets the value v for power change according to the control signal (9900). Similarly, the power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the control signal (9900).
The present invention is characterized in that the power changers (9901A and 9901B) respectively set the values v and u for power change according to the selected coding rate indicated by the control signal (9900). Here, values for power change set according to the coding rate rx are referred to as vrx, and urx.
For example, when r1 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vr1. When r2 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vr2. When r3 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vr3.
Also, when r1 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur1. When r2 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur2. When r3 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur3.
In this case, for example, by setting vr1, vr2 and vr3 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each code length. Similarly, by setting ur1, ur2 and ur3 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each coding rate. Depending on the set coding rate, however, the effect might not be obtained even if the value for power change is changed. In such a case, even when the coding rate is changed, it is unnecessary to change the value for power change (for example, vr1=vr2 may be satisfied, and ur1=ur2 may be satisfied. What is important is that two or more values exist in a set of vr1, vr2 and vr3, and that two or more values exist in a set of ur1, ur2 and ur3). Note that, as described above, vrX and urX are set so as to satisfy the ratio of the average power 1:w2.
Also, note that, as examples of r1, r2 and r3 described above, coding rates ½, ⅔ and ¾ are considered when the error correction code is the LDPC code.
Although the case of three coding rates is taken as an example in the above description, the present invention is not limited to this. One important point is that two or more values urx for power change exist when there are two or more coding rates that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values urx for power change when the coding rate is set, and performs power change. Another important point is that two or more values vrX for power change exist when there are two or more coding rates that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values vrX for power change when the coding rate is set, and performs power change.
In order for the reception device to achieve excellent data reception quality, it is important to implement the following.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a modulation scheme used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of modulation schemes.
Here, as an example, a case where the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to 64QAM and the modulation scheme for s2 is changed from 16QAM to QPSK by the control signal (or can be set to either 16QAM or QPSK) is considered. In a case where the modulation scheme for s1 is 64QAM, the mapping scheme for s1(t) is as shown in
In
In
Note that although “the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to 64QAM” in the description above, it is possible that “the modulation scheme for s2 is fixed to 64QAM and the modulation scheme for s1 is changed from 16QAM to QPSK (set to either 16QAM or QPSK)”, w4<w16<1.0 should be fulfilled. (The same as described in Example 4-3). (Note that the value used for the multiplication for the power change in the case of 16QAM is u=α×w16, the value used for the multiplication for the power change in the case of QPSK is u=β×w4, the value used for the power change in the case of 64QAM is v=α when the selectable modulation scheme is 16QAM and v=β when the selectable modulation scheme is QPSK). Also, when the set of (the modulation scheme for s1, the modulation scheme for s2) is selectable from the sets of (64QAM, 16QAM), (16QAM, 64QAM), (64QAM, QPSK) and (QPSK, 64QAM), w4<w16<1.0 should be fulfilled.
The following describes a case where the above-mentioned description is generalized.
For generalization, assume that the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to a modulation scheme C with which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is c. Also assume that the modulation scheme for s2 is selectable from a modulation scheme A with which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is a and a modulation scheme B with which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is b (c>b>a). In this case, when the modulation scheme for s2 is set to the modulation scheme A, assume that ratio between the average power of the modulation scheme for s1, which is the modulation scheme C, and the average power of the modulation scheme for s2, which is the modulation scheme A, is 1:wa2. Also, when the modulation scheme for s2 is set to the modulation scheme B, assume that ratio between the average power of the modulation scheme for s1, which is the modulation scheme C, and the average power of the modulation scheme for s2, which is the modulation scheme B, is 1:wb2. If this is the case, the reception device achieves a high data reception quality when wa<wb is fulfilled.
Note that although “the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to C” in the description above, even when “the modulation scheme for s2 is fixed to the modulation scheme C and the modulation scheme for s1 is changed from the modulation scheme A to the modulation scheme B (set to either the modulation scheme A or the modulation scheme B), the average powers should fulfill wa<wb. (If this is the case, as with the description above, when the average power of the modulation scheme is C, the average power of the modulation scheme A is wa2, and the average power of the modulation scheme B is wb2.) Also, when the set of (the modulation scheme for s1, the modulation scheme for s2) is selectable from the sets of (the modulation scheme C, the modulation scheme A), (the modulation scheme A, the modulation scheme C), (the modulation scheme C, the modulation scheme B) and (the modulation scheme B, the modulation scheme C), the average powers should fulfill wa<wb.
The following describes an example of the operation different from that described in Example 4, using
The power changer (9901A) receives a (mapped) baseband signal 307A for the modulation scheme 16QAM and the control signal (9900) as input. Letting a value for power change set based on the control signal (9900) be v, the power changer outputs a signal (9902A) obtained by multiplying the (mapped) baseband signal 307A for the modulation scheme 16QAM by v.
The power changer (9901B) receives a (mapped) baseband signal 307B for the modulation scheme 64QAM and a control signal (9900) as input. Letting a value for power change set based on the control signal (9900) be u, the power changer outputs a signal (9902B) obtained by multiplying the (mapped) baseband signal 307B for the modulation scheme 64QAM by u. Then, let u=v×w (w<1.0).
Letting the precoding matrix used in the scheme for regularly performing phase change on the modulated signal after precoding be F and the phase changing value used for regularly performing phase change be y(t) (y(t) may be imaginary number having the absolute value of 1, i.e. ejθ(t), formula 87 shown above is satisfied.
Therefore, a ratio of the average power for 64QAM to the average power for 16QAM is set to v2:u2=v2:v2×w2=1:w2. With this structure, the reception device is in a reception condition as shown in
In the conventional technology, transmission power control is generally performed based on feedback information from a communication partner. The present invention is characterized in that the transmission power is controlled regardless of the feedback information from the communication partner in the present embodiment. Detailed description is made on this point.
The above describes that the values v and u for power change are set based on the control signal (9900). The following describes setting of the values v and u for power change based on the control signal (9900) in order to improve data reception quality in the reception device in detail.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a block length (the number of bits constituting one coded block, and is also referred to as the code length) for the error correction codes used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of block lengths for the error correction codes.
Examples of the error correction codes include block codes such as Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, LDPC codes, or the like. In many communication systems and broadcasting systems, a plurality of block lengths are supported. Encoded data for which error correction codes whose block length is selected from among the plurality of supported block lengths has been performed is distributed to two systems. The encoded data having been distributed to the two systems is modulated in the modulation scheme for s1 and in the modulation scheme for s2 to generate the (mapped) baseband signals s1(t) and s2(t).
The control signal (9900) is a signal indicating the selected block length for the error correction codes described above. The power changer (9901B) sets the value v for power change according to the control signal (9900). Similarly, the power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the control signal (9900).
The present invention is characterized in that the power changers (9901A and 9901B) respectively set the values v and u for power change according to the selected block length indicated by the control signal (9900). Here, values for power change set according to the block length X are referred to as vLX and uLX.
For example, when 1000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vL1000. When 1500 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vL1500. When 3000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vL3000.
On the other hand, when 1000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL1000. When 1500 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL1500. When 3000 is selected as the block length, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to uL3000.
In this case, for example, by setting vL1000, vL1500 and vL3000 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each code length. Similarly, by setting uL1000, uL1500 and uL3000 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each code length. Depending on the set code length, however, the effect might not be obtained even if the value for power change is changed. In such a case, even when the code length is changed, it is unnecessary to change the value for power change (for example, uL1000=uL1500 may be satisfied, and vL1000=vL1500 may be satisfied. What is important is that two or more values exist in a set of vL1000, vL1500 and vL3000, and that two or more values exist in a set of uL1000, uL1500 and uL3000). Note that, as described above, vLX and uLX are set so as to satisfy the ratio of the average power 1:w2.
Although the case of three code lengths is taken as an example in the above description, the present invention is not limited to this. One important point is that two or more values uLX for power change exist when there are two or more code lengths that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values uLX for power change when the code length is set, and performs power change. Another important point is that two or more values vLX for power change exist when there are two or more code lengths that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values vLX for power change when the code length is set, and performs power change.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power of s1 and s2 according to a coding rate for the error correction codes used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of coding rates for the error correction codes.
Examples of the error correction codes include block codes such as Turbo codes or Duo-Binary Turbo codes using tail-biting, LDPC codes, or the like. In many communication systems and broadcasting systems, a plurality of coding rates are supported. Encoded data for which error correction codes whose coding rate is selected from among the plurality of supported coding rates has been performed is distributed to two systems. The encoded data having been distributed to the two systems is modulated in the modulation scheme for s1 and in the modulation scheme for s2 to generate the (mapped) baseband signals s1(t) and s2(t).
The control signal (9900) is a signal indicating the selected coding rate for the error correction codes described above. The power changer (9901A) sets the value v for power change according to the control signal (9900). Similarly, the power changer (9901B) sets the value u for power change according to the control signal (9900).
The present invention is characterized in that the power changers (9901A and 9901B) respectively set the values v and u for power change according to the selected coding rate indicated by the control signal (9900). Here, values for power change set according to the coding rate rx are referred to as vrx and urx.
For example, when r1 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vr1. When r2 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vr2. When r3 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901A) sets a value for power change to vr3.
Also, when r1 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur1. When r2 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur2. When r3 is selected as the coding rate, the power changer (9901B) sets a value for power change to ur3.
In this case, for example, by setting vr1, vr2 and vr3 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each code length. Similarly, by setting ur1, ur2 and ur3 so as to be different from one another, a high error correction capability can be achieved for each coding rate. Depending on the set coding rate, however, the effect might not be obtained even if the value for power change is changed. In such a case, even when the coding rate is changed, it is unnecessary to change the value for power change (for example, vr1=vr2 may be satisfied, and ur1=ur2 may be satisfied. What is important is that two or more values exist in a set of vr1, vr2 and vr3, and that two or more values exist in a set of ur1, ur2 and ur3). Note that, as described above, vrX and urX are set so as to satisfy the ratio of the average power 1:w2.
Also, note that, as examples of r1, r2 and r3 described above, coding rates ½, ⅔ and ¾ are considered when the error correction code is the LDPC code.
Although the case of three coding rates is taken as an example in the above description, the present invention is not limited to this. One important point is that two or more values urx for power change exist when there are two or more coding rates that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values u, for power change when the coding rate is set, and performs power change. Another important point is that two or more values vrX for power change exist when there are two or more coding rates that can be set, and the transmission device selects any of the values for power change from among the two or more values vrX for power change when the coding rate is set, and performs power change.
In order for the reception device to achieve excellent data reception quality, it is important to implement the following.
The following describes a scheme of setting the average power (average values) of s1 and s2 according to a modulation scheme used to generate s1 and s2 when the transmission device supports a plurality of modulation schemes.
Here, as an example, a case where the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to 16QAM and the modulation scheme for s2 is changed from 64QAM to QPSK by the control signal (or can be set to either 16QAM or QPSK) is considered. In a case where the modulation scheme for s1 is 16QAM, the mapping scheme for s1(t) is as shown in
In
In
Note that although “the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to 16QAM” in the description above, it is possible that “the modulation scheme for s2 is fixed to 16QAM and the modulation scheme for s1 is changed from 64QAM to QPSK (set to either 16 QAM or QPSK)”, w4<w64 should be fulfilled. (The same as described in Example 4-3). (Note that the value used for the multiplication for the power change in the case of 16QAM is u=α×w16, the value used for the multiplication for the power change in the case of QPSK is u=β×w4, the value used for the power change in the case of 64QAM is v=β when the selectable modulation scheme is 16QAM and v=β when the selectable modulation scheme is QPSK). Also, when the set of (the modulation scheme for s1, the modulation scheme for s2) is selectable from the sets of (16QAM, 64QAM), (64QAM, 16QAM), (16QAM, QPSK) and (QPSK, 16QAM), w4<w64 should be fulfilled.
The following describes a case where the above-mentioned description is generalized.
For generalization, assume that the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to a modulation scheme C with which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is c. Also assume that the modulation scheme for s2 is selectable from a modulation scheme A with which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is a and a modulation scheme B with which the number of signal points in the I-Q plane is b (c>b>a). In this case, when the modulation scheme for s2 is set to the modulation scheme A, assume that ratio between the average power of the modulation scheme for s1, which is the modulation scheme C, and the average power of the modulation scheme for s2, which is the modulation scheme A, is 1:wa2. Also, when the modulation scheme for s2 is set to the modulation scheme B, assume that ratio between the average power of the modulation scheme for s1, which is the modulation scheme C, and the average power of the modulation scheme for s2, which is the modulation scheme B, is 1:wb2. If this is the case, the reception device achieves a high data reception quality when wa<wb is fulfilled.
Note that although “the modulation scheme for s1 is fixed to C” in the description above, even when “the modulation scheme for s2 is fixed to the modulation scheme C and the modulation scheme for s1 is changed from the modulation scheme A to the modulation scheme B (set to either the modulation scheme A or the modulation scheme B), the average powers should fulfill wa<wb. (If this is the case, as with the description above, when the average power of the modulation scheme is C, the average power of the modulation scheme A is wa2, and the average power of the modulation scheme B is wb2.) Also, when the set of (the modulation scheme for s1 and the modulation scheme for s2) is selectable from the sets of (the modulation scheme C and the modulation scheme A), (the modulation scheme A and the modulation scheme C), (the modulation scheme C and the modulation scheme B) and (the modulation scheme B and the modulation scheme C), the average powers should fulfill wa<wb.
In the present description including “Embodiment 1”, and so on, the power consumption by the transmission device can be reduced by setting α=1 in the formula 36 representing the precoding matrices used for the scheme for regularly changing the phase. This is because the average power of z1 and the average power of z2 are the same even when “the average power (average value) of s1 and the average power (average value) of s2 are set to be different when the modulation scheme for s1 and the modulation scheme for s2 are different”, and setting α=1 does not result in increasing the PAPR (Peak-to-Average Power Ratio) of the transmission power amplifier provided in the transmission device.
However, even when α≠1, there are some precoding matrices that can be used with the scheme that regularly changes the phase and have limited influence to PAPR. For example, when the precoding matrices represented by formula 36 in Embodiment 1 are used to achieve the scheme for regularly changing the phase, the precoding matrices have limited influence to PAPR even when α≠1.
Operations of the Reception Device
Subsequently, explanation is provided of the operations of the reception device. Explanation of the reception device has already been provided in Embodiment 1 and so on, and the structure of the reception device is illustrated in
According to the relation illustrated in
In the case of Example 1, Example 2 and Example 3, the following relationship shown in formula 89 is derived from
Also, as explained in Example 1, Example 2, and Example 3, the relationship may be as shown in formula 90 below:
The reception device performs demodulation (detection) (i.e. estimates the bits transmitted by the transmission device) by using the relationships described above (in the same manner as described in Embodiment 1 and so on).
In the case of Example 4, Example 5 and Example 6, the following relationship shown in formula 91 is derived from
Also, as explained in Example 3, Example 4, and Example 5, the relationship may be as shown in formula 92 below:
The reception device performs demodulation (detection) (i.e. estimates the bits transmitted by the transmission device) by using the relationships described above (in the same manner as described in Embodiment 1 and so on).
Note that although Examples 1 through 6 show the case where the power changer is added to the transmission device, the power change may be performed at the stage of mapping.
As described in Example 1, Example 2, and Example 3, and as particularly shown in formula 89, the mapper 306B in
As described in Example 1, Example 2, and Example 3, and as particularly shown in formula 90, the mapper 306A in
In Example 4, Example 5, and Example 6, as particularly shown in formula 91, the mapper 306A in
In Example 4, Example 5, and Example 6, as particularly shown in formula 92, the mapper 306A in
Note that F shown in formulas 89 through 92 denotes precoding matrices used at time t, and y(t) denotes phase changing values. The reception device performs demodulation (detection) by using the relationships between r1(t), r2(t) and s1(t), s2(t) described above (in the same manner as described in Embodiment 1 and so on). However, distortion components, such as noise components, frequency offset, channel estimation error, and the likes are not considered in the formulas described above. Hence, demodulation (detection) is performed with them. Regarding the values u and v that the transmission device uses for performing the power change, the transmission device transmits information about these values, or transmits information of the transmission mode (such as the transmission scheme, the modulation scheme and the error correction scheme) to be used. The reception device detects the values used by the transmission device by acquiring the information, obtains the relationships described above, and performs the demodulation (detection).
In the present embodiment, the switching between the phase changing values is performed on the modulated signal after precoding in the time domain. However, when a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM scheme is used, the present invention is applicable to the case where the switching between the phase changing values is performed on the modulated signal after precoding in the frequency domain, as described in other embodiments. If this is the case, t used in the present embodiment is to be replaced with f (frequency ((sub) carrier)).
Accordingly, in the case of performing the switching between the phase changing values on the modulated signal after precoding in the time domain, z1(t) and z2(t) at the same time point is transmitted from different antennas by using the same (common/shared) frequency. On the other hand, in the case of performing the switching between the phase changing values on the modulated signal after precoding in the frequency domain, z1(f) and z2(f) at the same (common/shared) frequency is transmitted from different antennas at the same time point.
Also, even in the case of performing switching between the phase changing values on the modulated signal after precoding in the time and frequency domains, the present invention is applicable as described in other embodiments. The scheme pertaining to the present embodiment, which switches between the phase changing values on the modulated signal after precoding, is not limited the scheme which switches between the phase changing values on the modulated signal after precoding as described in the present Description.
Also, assume that processed baseband signals z1(i), z2(i) (where i represents the order in terms of time or frequency (carrier)) are generated by regular phase change and precoding (it does not matter which is performed first) on baseband signals s1(i) and s2(i) for two streams. Let the in-phase component I and the quadrature component Q of the processed baseband signal z1(i) be I1(i) and Q1(i) respectively, and let the in-phase component I and the quadrature component Q of the processed baseband signal z2(i) be I2(i) and Q2(i) respectively. In this case, the baseband components may be switched, and modulated signals corresponding to the switched baseband signal r1(i) and the switched baseband signal r2(i) may be transmitted from different antennas at the same time and over the same (common/shared) frequency by transmitting a modulated signal corresponding to the switched baseband signal r1(i) from transmit antenna 1 and a modulated signal corresponding to the switched baseband signal r2(i) from transmit antenna 2 at the same time and over the same (common/shared) frequency. Baseband components may be switched as follows.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i) and Q2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i) and I2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i) and Q2(i) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i) and Q2(i) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i) and I2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i) and Q2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i) and I2(i) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i) and I2(i) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i) and I2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i) and Q2(i) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i) and Q2(i) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i) and I2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i) and Q2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i) and Q2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i) and I2(i) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i) and I2(i) respectively.
In the above description, signals in two streams are processed and in-phase components and quadrature components of the processed signals are switched, but the present invention is not limited in this way. Signals in more than two streams may be processed, and the in-phase components and quadrature components of the processed signals may be switched.
In addition, the signals may be switched in the following manner. For example,
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i) and Q2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i) and Q1(i) respectively.
Such switching can be achieved by the structure shown in
In the above-mentioned example, switching between baseband signals at the same time (at the same (common/shared) frequency ((sub)carrier)) has been described, but the present invention is not limited to the switching between baseband signals at the same time. As an example, the following description can be made.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively.
In addition, the signals may be switched in the following manner. For example,
Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i+w) and Q2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i+v) and Q1(i+w) respectively.
This can also be achieved by the structure shown in
The switching may be performed while regularly changing switching methods.
For example,
At time 0,
for switched baseband signal r1(0), the in-phase component may be I1(0) while the quadrature component may be Q1(0), and for switched baseband signal r2(0), the in-phase component may be I2(0) while the quadrature component may be Q2(0);
At time 1,
for switched baseband signal r1(1), the in-phase component may be I2(1) while the quadrature component may be Q2(1), and for switched baseband signal r2(1), the in-phase component may be Ii(1) while the quadrature component may be Q1(1), and so on. In other words,
When time is 2k (k is an integer),
for switched baseband signal r1(2k), the in-phase component may be I1(2k) while the quadrature component may be Q1(2k), and for switched baseband signal r2(2k), the in-phase component may be I2(2k) while the quadrature component may be Q2(2k).
When time is 2k+1 (k is an integer),
for switched baseband signal r1(2k+1), the in-phase component may be I2(2k+1) while the quadrature component may be Q2(2k+1), and for switched baseband signal r2(2k+1), the in-phase component may be I1(2k+1) while the quadrature component may be Qi(2k+1).
When time is 2k (k is an integer),
for switched baseband signal r1(2k), the in-phase component may be I2(2k) while the quadrature component may be Q2(2k), and for switched baseband signal r2(2k), the in-phase component may be I1(2k) while the quadrature component may be Q1(2k).
When time is 2k+1 (k is an integer),
for switched baseband signal r1(2k+1), the in-phase component may be I1(2k+1) while the quadrature component may be Q1(2k+1), and for switched baseband signal r2(2k+1), the in-phase component may be I2(2k+1) while the quadrature component may be Q2(2k+1).
Similarly, the switching may be performed in the frequency domain. In other words,
When frequency ((sub) carrier) is 2k (k is an integer),
for switched baseband signal r1(2k), the in-phase component may be I1(2k) while the quadrature component may be Q1(2k), and for switched baseband signal r2(2k), the in-phase component may be I2(2k) while the quadrature component may be Q2(2k).
When frequency ((sub) carrier) is 2k+1 (k is an integer),
for switched baseband signal r1(2k+1), the in-phase component may be I2(2k+1) while the quadrature component may be Q2(2k+1), and for switched baseband signal r2(2k+1), the in-phase component may be I1(2k+1) while the quadrature component may be Q1(2k+1).
When frequency ((sub) carrier) is 2k (k is an integer),
for switched baseband signal r1(2k), the in-phase component may be I2(2k) while the quadrature component may be Q2(2k), and for switched baseband signal r2(2k), the in-phase component may be I1(2k) while the quadrature component may be Q1(2k).
When frequency ((sub) carrier) is 2k+1 (k is an integer),
for switched baseband signal r1(2k+1), the in-phase component may be I1(2k+1) while the quadrature component may be Q1(2k+1), and for switched baseband signal r2(2k+1), the in-phase component may be I2(2k+1) while the quadrature component may be Q2(2k+1).
(Regarding Cyclic Q Delay)
The following describes the application of the Cyclic Q Delay mentioned throughout the present disclosure. Non-Patent Literature 10 describes the overall concept of Cyclic Q Delay. The following describes a specific example of a generation method for the s1 and s2 signals when Cyclic Q Delay is used.
A mapper 10302 takes data 10301 and a control signal 10306 as input, and performs mapping in accordance with the modulation scheme of the control signal 10306. For example, when 16-QAM is selected as the modulation scheme, mapping is performed as illustrated in
Here, the data at time 1 corresponding to the bits b0, b1, b2, and b3 from
A memory and signal switcher 10304 takes the in-phase component 10303_A and the quadrature component 10303_B of the baseband signal as input and, in accordance with a control signal 10306, stores the in-phase component 10303_A and the quadrature component 10303_B of the baseband signal, switches the signals, and outputs modulated signal s1(t) (10305_A) and modulated signal s2(t) (10305_B). The generation method for the modulated signals s1(t) and s2(t) is described in detail below.
As described elsewhere in the disclosure, precoding and phase changing are performed on the modulated signal s1(t) and s2(t). Here, as described elsewhere, signal processing involving phase change, power change, signal switching, and so on may be applied at any step. Thus, modulated signals r1(t) and r2(t), respectively obtained by applying the precoding and phase change to the modulated signals s1(t) and s2(t), are transmitted using the same (common) frequency band at the same (common) time.
Although the above description is given with respect to the time domain, s1(t) and s2(t) may be thought of as s1(f) and s2(f) (where f is the (sub-)carrier frequency) when a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM is employed. In contrast to the modulated signals s1(f) and s2(f), modulated signals r1(f) and r2(f) obtained using a precoding scheme in which the precoding matrix is regularly changed are transmitted at the same (common) time (r1(f) and r2(f) being, of course) signals of the same (common/shared) frequency band). Also, as described above, s1(t) and s2(t) may be treated as s1(t,f) and s2(t,f).
The following describes the generation method for modulated signals s1(t) and s2(t).
Portion (a) of
Portion (b) of
Accordingly, given that signal switching is not performed on the in-phase component of the baseband signal, the order thereof is such that in-phase component I1 occurs at time 1, in-phase component I2 occurs at time 2, baseband signal I3 occurs at time 3, and so on.
Then, signal switching is performed within the pairs of quadrature components for the baseband signal. Thus, quadrature component Q2 occurs at time 1, quadrature component Q1 occurs at time 2, quadrature component Q4 occurs at time 3, quadrature component Q3 occurs at time 4, and so on.
Portion (c) of
Although
Then, N-slot precoded and phase changed modulated signals r1(t) and r2(t) are obtained after applying the precoding and phase change to the N-slot modulated signals s1(t) and s2(t). This point is described elsewhere in the present disclosure.
The generation method for the first slot (I1, Q2) of modulated signal s1(t) (10503_A) and the first slot (I2, Q1) of modulated signal s2(t) (10503_B) by the mapper 10502 from
The data 10501 indicated in
The data 10501 input to the mapper 10601_A and the data 10501 input to the mapper 10601_B are, of course, identical data. Modulated signal s1(t) (10503_A) is identical to modulated signal 10305_A from
Accordingly, the first slot of modulated signal s1(t) (10503_A) takes (I1, Q2), the first slot of modulated signal s2(t) (10503_B) takes (I2, Q1), the second slot of modulated signal s1(t) (10503_A) takes (I3, Q4), the second slot of modulated signal s2(t) (10503_B) takes (I4, Q3), and so on.
The generation method for the first slot (I1, Q2) of modulated signal s1(t) (10503_A) by the mapper 10601_A from
The generation method for the first slot (I2, Q1) of modulated signal s2(t) (10503_B) by the mapper 10601_B from
Next,
Portion (a) of
Portion (b) of
Portion (c) of
Accordingly, in contrast to portion (b) of
Thus, the first slot of s1(t) has an in-phase component I1 and a quadrature component Q3, and the first slot of s2(t) has an in-phase component I2 and a quadrature component Q4. Also, the second slot of s1(t) has an in-phase component I3 and a quadrature component Q1, and the second slot of s2(t) has an in-phase component I4 and a quadrature component Q4. The third and fourth slots are as indicated in portion (c) of
Then, N-slot precoded and phase changed modulated signals r1(t) and r2(t) are obtained after applying the precoding and phase change to the N-slot modulated signals s1(t) and s2(t). This point is described elsewhere in the present disclosure.
The generation method for the first slot (I1, Q3) of modulated signal s1(t) (10503_A), the first slot (I2, Q4) of modulated signal s2(t) (10503_B), the second slot (I3, Q1) of modulated signal s1(t) (10503_A), and the second slot (I4, Q2) of modulated signal s2(t) (10503_B) by the mapper 10502 from
The data 10501 indicated in
Accordingly, the first slot of modulated signal s1(t) (10503_A) takes (I1, Q3), the first slot of modulated signal s2(t) (10503_B) takes (I2, Q4), the second slot of modulated signal s1(t) (10503_A) takes (I3, Q1), the second slot of modulated signal s2(t) (10503_B) takes (I4, Q2), and so on.
The generation method for the first slot (I1, Q3) of modulated signal s1(t) (10503_A) and the first slot (I3, Q1) of modulated signal s2(t) (10503_B) by the mapper 10601_A from
The generation method for the first slot (I2, Q4) of modulated signal s2(t) (10503_B) and the second slot (I4, Q2) by the mapper 10601_B from
Although two methods using cyclic Q delay are described above, when the signals are switched among slot pairs as per
Although the above description uses examples of a 16-QAM modulation scheme, no limitation is intended. The same applies to other modulation schemes, such as QPSK, 8-QAM, 32-QAM, 64-QAM, 128-QAM, 256-QAM and so on.
Also, the cyclic Q delay method is not limited to the two schemes given above. For example, either of the two schemes given above may involve switching either of the quadrature component or the in-phase component of the baseband signal. Also, while the above describes switching performed at two times (e.g., switching the quadrature components of the baseband signal at times 1 and 2), the in-phase components and (or) the quadrature components of the baseband signal may also be switched at a plurality of times. Accordingly, when the in-phase components and quadrature components of the baseband signal are generated and cyclic Q delay is performed as in
The precoding and phase change are then applied to the modulated signals s1(t) (or s1(f), or s1(t,f)) and s2(t) (or s2(f) or s2(t,f)) obtained by applying the above-described cyclic Q delay. (Here, as described elsewhere, signal processing involving phase change, power change, signal switching, and so on may be applied at any step.) Here, the precoding and phase changing application method used on the modulated signal obtained with the cyclic Q delay may be any of the precoding and phase changing methods described in the present disclosure.
The present invention is widely applicable to wireless systems that transmit different modulated signals from a plurality of antennas, such as an OFDM-MIMO system. Also, the present invention is also applicable in a wired system having multiple connections (e.g., a power line communication system, a fibre-optic system, a digital subscriber line system, and so on) when MIMO transmission is used, and the modulated signals described in the present document are applied. The modulated signals may also be transmitted from a plurality of transmission locations.
Kimura, Tomohiro, Murakami, Yutaka, Ouchi, Mikihiro
Patent | Priority | Assignee | Title |
Patent | Priority | Assignee | Title |
8213530, | Sep 19 2006 | LG Electronics Inc | Method of transmitting using phase shift-based precoding and an apparatus for implementing the same in a wireless communication system |
8254476, | Feb 15 2008 | NTT DoCoMo, Inc; Tokyo Institute of Technology | Wireless communication device and wireless communication method |
8284849, | May 26 2006 | LG Electronics Inc. | Phase shift based precoding method and transceiver for supporting the same |
20040042439, | |||
20050249304, | |||
20070140377, | |||
20070268977, | |||
20080080449, | |||
20100027696, | |||
20110176624, | |||
20120224651, | |||
20120300877, | |||
EP2312778, | |||
EP2677676, | |||
JP2005123898, | |||
JP2005192126, | |||
JP2005354665, | |||
JP2009171155, | |||
JP2009525665, | |||
JP2010518763, | |||
JP2010519794, | |||
WO2005050885, | |||
WO2007089110, | |||
WO2008035915, | |||
WO2008098092, | |||
WO2008098225, | |||
WO2008100038, | |||
WO2010016183, |
Executed on | Assignor | Assignee | Conveyance | Frame | Reel | Doc |
Apr 18 2012 | Panasonic Intellectual Property Corporation of America | (assignment on the face of the patent) | / |
Date | Maintenance Fee Events |
Date | Maintenance Schedule |
Jan 27 2018 | 4 years fee payment window open |
Jul 27 2018 | 6 months grace period start (w surcharge) |
Jan 27 2019 | patent expiry (for year 4) |
Jan 27 2021 | 2 years to revive unintentionally abandoned end. (for year 4) |
Jan 27 2022 | 8 years fee payment window open |
Jul 27 2022 | 6 months grace period start (w surcharge) |
Jan 27 2023 | patent expiry (for year 8) |
Jan 27 2025 | 2 years to revive unintentionally abandoned end. (for year 8) |
Jan 27 2026 | 12 years fee payment window open |
Jul 27 2026 | 6 months grace period start (w surcharge) |
Jan 27 2027 | patent expiry (for year 12) |
Jan 27 2029 | 2 years to revive unintentionally abandoned end. (for year 12) |